blob: a4973ecb705585bee6ea4c5a69867aa68cb577ea [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau69eda352012-12-24 16:48:14 +01007 2012/12/24
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100828.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200838.3. Advanced logging options
848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
858.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
868.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
888.4. Timing events
898.5. Session state at disconnection
908.6. Non-printable characters
918.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
938.9. Examples of logs
94
959. Statistics and monitoring
969.1. CSV format
979.2. Unix Socket commands
98
99
1001. Quick reminder about HTTP
101----------------------------
102
103When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
104fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
105on almost anything found in the contents.
106
107However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
108formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
109correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
110
111
1121.1. The HTTP transaction model
113-------------------------------
114
115The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100116to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
118connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
119will involve a new connection :
120
121 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
122
123In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
124establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
125by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
126length.
127
128Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
129to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
130however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
131response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
132header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
133
134 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
135
136Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
137power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
138but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200139a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140
141A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
142keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
143second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
144page :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
149latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
150correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
151the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100152server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200154By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
155connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
156everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
157established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
158sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
159while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
160another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
161sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
162http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
163mode.
164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
1661.2. HTTP request
167-----------------
168
169First, let's consider this HTTP request :
170
171 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100172 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
174 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
175 3 User-agent: my small browser
176 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
177 5 Accept: image/png
178
179
1801.2.1. The Request line
181-----------------------
182
183Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
184
185 - a METHOD : GET
186 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
187 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
188
189All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
190which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
191followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
192is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
193desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
194the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
195
196The URI itself can have several forms :
197
198 - A "relative URI" :
199
200 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201
202 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
203 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
204
205 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
206
207 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
210 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
211 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
212 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
213 must accept this form too.
214
215 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
216 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
217 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
220 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
221 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
222 other protocols too.
223
224In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
225mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
226on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
227It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
228specific to the language, framework or application in use.
229
230
2311.2.2. The request headers
232--------------------------
233
234The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
235beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
236an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
237Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
238values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
239encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
240the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
241define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
242
243Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
244their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
245"Connection:" header).
246
247The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
248that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
249is one valid form of empty line.
250
251Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
252headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
253about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
254application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
255
256Important note:
257 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
258 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
259 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
260 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
261
262
2631.3. HTTP response
264------------------
265
266An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
267messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
268
269 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100270 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
272 2 Content-length: 350
273 3 Content-Type: text/html
274
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200275As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
276codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
277response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100278continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
279the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
280following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
281sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
282(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
283correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
284such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
285state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
286over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
287if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
288information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200290
2911.3.1. The Response line
292------------------------
293
294Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
295
296 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
297 - a status code : 200
298 - a reason : OK
299
300The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
303 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
304 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
305 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
306
307Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100308"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
310messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
311or "Authentication Required".
312
313Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
314
315 Code When / reason
316 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
317 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
320 400 for an invalid or too large request
321 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
322 accessing the stats page)
323 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
324 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
325 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
326 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
327 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
328 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
329 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
330 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
331 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
332
333The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3344.2).
335
336
3371.3.2. The response headers
338---------------------------
339
340Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
341the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
342details.
343
344
3452. Configuring HAProxy
346----------------------
347
3482.1. Configuration file format
349------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200350
351HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
352
353 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
354 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
355 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
356 "frontend" and "backend".
357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
359referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
360delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100361preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100362escaped by doubling them.
363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
3652.2. Time format
366----------------
367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100368Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
370otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
371numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
372for every keyword. Supported units are :
373
374 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
375 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
376 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
377 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
378 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
379 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
380
381
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003822.3. Examples
383-------------
384
385 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
386 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
387 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
388 global
389 daemon
390 maxconn 256
391
392 defaults
393 mode http
394 timeout connect 5000ms
395 timeout client 50000ms
396 timeout server 50000ms
397
398 frontend http-in
399 bind *:80
400 default_backend servers
401
402 backend servers
403 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
404
405
406 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
407 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
408 global
409 daemon
410 maxconn 256
411
412 defaults
413 mode http
414 timeout connect 5000ms
415 timeout client 50000ms
416 timeout server 50000ms
417
418 listen http-in
419 bind *:80
420 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
421
422
423Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
424
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100425 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200426
427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004283. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200429--------------------
430
431Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
432are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
433of them have command-line equivalents.
434
435The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
436
437 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200438 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200440 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - daemon
442 - gid
443 - group
444 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100445 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200446 - nbproc
447 - pidfile
448 - uid
449 - ulimit-n
450 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200451 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200452 - node
453 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100454 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100455
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 * Performance tuning
457 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200458 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100459 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100460 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100461 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200462 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200463 - noepoll
464 - nokqueue
465 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100466 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200467 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200468 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200469 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100470 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100471 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200472 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100473 - tune.maxaccept
474 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200475 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200476 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100477 - tune.rcvbuf.client
478 - tune.rcvbuf.server
479 - tune.sndbuf.client
480 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100481 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100482 - tune.zlib.memlevel
483 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200485 * Debugging
486 - debug
487 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488
489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004903.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491------------------------------------
492
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493ca-base <dir>
494 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200495 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
496 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498chroot <jail dir>
499 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
500 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
501 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
502 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
503 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
504 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100505
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100506cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
507 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
508 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
509 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
510 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
511 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
512 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
513 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
514 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
515 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
516 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
517 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
518 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
519 they overlap.
520
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521crt-base <dir>
522 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
523 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
524 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526daemon
527 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
528 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
529 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
530
531gid <number>
532 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
533 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
534 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
535 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100536
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537group <group name>
538 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
539 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100540
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200541log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
543 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100544 configured with "log global".
545
546 <address> can be one of:
547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100548 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100549 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
550 port).
551
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100552 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
553 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
554 port).
555
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100556 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
557 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
558 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
559 writeable).
560
561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562
563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
566
567 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200568 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
569 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
570 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
571 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
572 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
573 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200575 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100577log-send-hostname [<string>]
578 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
579 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
580 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
581 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
582 the logs.
583
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000584log-tag <string>
585 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
586 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
587 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
588 running on the same host.
589
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590nbproc <number>
591 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
592 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
593 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
594 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
595 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
596
597pidfile <pidfile>
598 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
599 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
600 starting the process. See also "daemon".
601
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100602stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200603 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
604 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
605 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
606 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
607 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
608 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
609 the number of processes used.
610
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200611stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
612 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
613 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
614 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
615 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200616
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200617 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
618 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
619 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620
621stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
622 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
623 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100624 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625
626stats maxconn <connections>
627 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
628 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630uid <number>
631 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
632 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
633 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
634 one. See also "gid" and "user".
635
636ulimit-n <number>
637 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
638 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
639 option.
640
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100641unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
642 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
643
644 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
645 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
646 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
647 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
648 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
649 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
650 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
651 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
652 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
653 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655user <user name>
656 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
657 See also "uid" and "group".
658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200659node <name>
660 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
661
662 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
663 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
664 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
665 traffic.
666
667description <text>
668 Add a text that describes the instance.
669
670 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
671 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
672 "<" and ">" characters.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006753.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676-----------------------
677
678maxconn <number>
679 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
680 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
681 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
682 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
683
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200684maxconnrate <number>
685 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
686 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
687 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
688 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
689 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
690 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
691 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
692 fairness.
693
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100694maxcomprate <number>
695 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
696 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
697 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
698 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
699 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
700 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
701 default value.
702
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100703maxcompcpuusage <number>
704 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
705 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
706 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
707 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
708 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
709 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
710 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
711 process down and from introducing high latencies.
712
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100713maxpipes <number>
714 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
715 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
716 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
717 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
718 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
719 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
720
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200721maxsslconn <number>
722 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
723 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
724 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
725 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
726 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
727 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
728 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
729
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100730maxzlibmem <number>
731 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
732 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
733 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100734 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
735 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
736 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738noepoll
739 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
740 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100741 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
743nokqueue
744 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
745 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
746 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
747
748nopoll
749 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
750 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100751 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100752 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100754nosplice
755 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
756 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
757 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100758 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100759 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
760 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
761 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
762 "option splice-response".
763
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200764spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
765 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
766 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
767 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
768 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
769 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
770
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200771tune.bufsize <number>
772 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
773 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
774 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
775 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
776 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
777 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
778 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
779 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400780 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
781 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
782 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200783
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200784tune.chksize <number>
785 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
786 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
787 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
788 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
789 checks whenever possible.
790
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100791tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
792 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
793 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
794 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
795 this value. The default value is 1.
796
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100797tune.http.cookielen <number>
798 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
799 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
800 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
801 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
802 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
803 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
804 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
805 to change this value.
806
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200807tune.http.maxhdr <number>
808 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
809 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
810 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
811 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
812 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
813 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
814 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
815 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
816 limit too high.
817
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100818tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100819 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
820 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
821 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
822 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
823 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
824 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
825 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
826 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
827 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
828 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100829
830tune.maxpollevents <number>
831 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
832 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
833 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
834 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
835 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
836
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200837tune.maxrewrite <number>
838 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
839 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
840 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
841 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
842 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
843 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
844 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
845 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
846 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
847 bufsize.
848
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200849tune.pipesize <number>
850 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
851 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
852 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
853 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
854 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
855 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
856
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100857tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
858tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
859 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
860 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
861 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
862 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
863 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
864 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
865 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
866
867tune.sndbuf.client <number>
868tune.sndbuf.server <number>
869 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
870 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
871 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
872 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
873 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
874 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
875 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
876 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
877 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
878 notifying haproxy again.
879
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100880tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100881 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
882 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
883 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
884 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
885 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
886 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
887 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
888 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
889 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
890 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100891
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100892tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
893 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
894 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
895 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
896 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
897 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
898 being used for too long.
899
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100900tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
901 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
902 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
903 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
904 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
905 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
906
907tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
908 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
909 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
910 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
911 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009133.3. Debugging
914--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915
916debug
917 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
918 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
919 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
920 system startup.
921
922quiet
923 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
924 line argument "-q".
925
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009273.4. Userlists
928--------------
929It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
930http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
931it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
932
933userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100934 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100935 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
936
937group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100938 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100939 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
940 proceeded by "users" keyword.
941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100942user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
943 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100944 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
945 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100946 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
947 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100948 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
949 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
950
951
952 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100953 userlist L1
954 group G1 users tiger,scott
955 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100956
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100957 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
958 user scott insecure-password elgato
959 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100960
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100961 userlist L2
962 group G1
963 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100964
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100965 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
966 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
967 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100968
969 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200971
9723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200973----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200974It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
975haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
976pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
977identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
978or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
979Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
980known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
981the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
982process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
983during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
984tables.
985
986peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400987 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200988 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
989
990peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
991 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
992 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
993 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
994 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
995 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
996 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
997
998 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
999 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1000
1001 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1002 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1003 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1004 across all peers.
1005
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001006 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001007 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001008 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1009 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1010 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001011
1012 backend mybackend
1013 mode tcp
1014 balance roundrobin
1015 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1016 stick on src
1017
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001018 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1019 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001020
1021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010224. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001024
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001025Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1026 - defaults <name>
1027 - frontend <name>
1028 - backend <name>
1029 - listen <name>
1030
1031A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1032its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1033section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001034section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1037connections.
1038
1039A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1040to forward incoming connections.
1041
1042A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1043parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001045All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1046'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1047case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1048
1049Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1050logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1051proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1052However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1053name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1054
1055Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1056and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001057bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001058protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1059modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1060arbitrary criteria.
1061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010634.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1064--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001066The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1067limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1068they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1069limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001070marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001071option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001072and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1073with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1074specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001075
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001077 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1078------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1079acl - X X X
1080appsession - - X X
1081backlog X X X -
1082balance X - X X
1083bind - X X -
1084bind-process X X X X
1085block - X X X
1086capture cookie - X X -
1087capture request header - X X -
1088capture response header - X X -
1089clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001090compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1092cookie X - X X
1093default-server X - X X
1094default_backend X X X -
1095description - X X X
1096disabled X X X X
1097dispatch - - X X
1098enabled X X X X
1099errorfile X X X X
1100errorloc X X X X
1101errorloc302 X X X X
1102-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1103errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001104force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001105fullconn X - X X
1106grace X X X X
1107hash-type X - X X
1108http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001109http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001110http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001111http-request - X X X
1112id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001113ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001114log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001115maxconn X X X -
1116mode X X X X
1117monitor fail - X X -
1118monitor-net X X X -
1119monitor-uri X X X -
1120option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1121option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1122option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1123option allbackups (*) X - X X
1124option checkcache (*) X - X X
1125option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1126option contstats (*) X X X -
1127option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1128option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1129option forceclose (*) X X X X
1130-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1131option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001132option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001133option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001134option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1135option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1136option httpchk X - X X
1137option httpclose (*) X X X X
1138option httplog X X X X
1139option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001140option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001141option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001142option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1143option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1144option logasap (*) X X X -
1145option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001146option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001147option nolinger (*) X X X X
1148option originalto X X X X
1149option persist (*) X - X X
1150option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001151option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001152option smtpchk X - X X
1153option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1154option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1155option splice-request (*) X X X X
1156option splice-response (*) X X X X
1157option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1158option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1159-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1160option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1161option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1162option tcpka X X X X
1163option tcplog X X X X
1164option transparent (*) X - X X
1165persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1166rate-limit sessions X X X -
1167redirect - X X X
1168redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1169redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1170reqadd - X X X
1171reqallow - X X X
1172reqdel - X X X
1173reqdeny - X X X
1174reqiallow - X X X
1175reqidel - X X X
1176reqideny - X X X
1177reqipass - X X X
1178reqirep - X X X
1179reqisetbe - X X X
1180reqitarpit - X X X
1181reqpass - X X X
1182reqrep - X X X
1183-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1184reqsetbe - X X X
1185reqtarpit - X X X
1186retries X - X X
1187rspadd - X X X
1188rspdel - X X X
1189rspdeny - X X X
1190rspidel - X X X
1191rspideny - X X X
1192rspirep - X X X
1193rsprep - X X X
1194server - - X X
1195source X - X X
1196srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001197stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001198stats auth X - X X
1199stats enable X - X X
1200stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001201stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001202stats realm X - X X
1203stats refresh X - X X
1204stats scope X - X X
1205stats show-desc X - X X
1206stats show-legends X - X X
1207stats show-node X - X X
1208stats uri X - X X
1209-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1210stick match - - X X
1211stick on - - X X
1212stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001213stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001214stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001215tcp-request connection - X X -
1216tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001217tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001218tcp-response content - - X X
1219tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001220timeout check X - X X
1221timeout client X X X -
1222timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1223timeout connect X - X X
1224timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1225timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1226timeout http-request X X X X
1227timeout queue X - X X
1228timeout server X - X X
1229timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1230timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001231timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001232transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001233unique-id-format X X X -
1234unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001235use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001236use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001237------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1238 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1242---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
1244This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1245
1246
1247acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1248 Declare or complete an access list.
1249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1250 no | yes | yes | yes
1251 Example:
1252 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1253 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1254 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001256 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001257
1258
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001259appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1260 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1263 no | no | yes | yes
1264 Arguments :
1265 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1266 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1267
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001268 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001269 checked in each cookie value.
1270
1271 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1272 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1273 milliseconds.
1274
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001275 request-learn
1276 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1277 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1278 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1279 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1280 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1281 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1282
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001283 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1284 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1285 data following this prefix.
1286
1287 Example :
1288 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1289
1290 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1291 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1292
1293 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1294 2 modes are currently supported :
1295 - path-parameters :
1296 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1297 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1298 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1299 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1300 - query-string :
1301 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1302 query string.
1303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001304 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1305 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1306 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1307 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001308 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1309 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1310 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001311 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1312 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1313
1314 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1315
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001316 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1317 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1318 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001320 Example :
1321 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1322
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001323 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1324 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001325
1326
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001327backlog <conns>
1328 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1330 yes | yes | yes | no
1331 Arguments :
1332 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1333 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001334 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001335
1336 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1337 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1338 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1339 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1340 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1341 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1342 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1343 backlog parameter.
1344
1345 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1346 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1347 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1348
1349 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1350
1351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001352balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001353balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1356 yes | no | yes | yes
1357 Arguments :
1358 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1359 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1360 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1361 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1362
1363 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1364 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1365 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1366 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001367 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1368 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1369 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1370 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1371 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1372 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1373 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1374 it, so that you don't worry.
1375
1376 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1377 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1378 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1379 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1380 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1381 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1382 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1383 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001384
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001385 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1386 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1387 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1388 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1389 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1390 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1391 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1392 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1393
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001394 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1395 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1396 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1397 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001398 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001399 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1400 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1401 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1402 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1403 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001404 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1405 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1406 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1407 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1408 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1409 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001411 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1412 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1413 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1414 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1415 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1416 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1417 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1418 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001419 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001421 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1422 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1423 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001425 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1426 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1427 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1428 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1429 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1430 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1431 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1432 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1433 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1434 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1435 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1436 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001438 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001439 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1440 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1441 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1442 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1443 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1444 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1445 URIs start with a leading "/".
1446
1447 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1448 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1449 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1450 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001452 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001453 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1454
1455 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001456 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1457 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1458 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1459 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1460 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1461 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1462 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1463 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1464 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1465 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1466 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1467 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1468 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1469 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1470 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1471 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1472 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1473 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1474 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001475
1476 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1477 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1478 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1479 server will receive the request.
1480
1481 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1482 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1483 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1484 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1485 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001486 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1487 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1488 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001490 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1491 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1492 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1493 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1494 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001496 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001497 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1498 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1499 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1500
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001501 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1502 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1503 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1504
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001505 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001506 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001507 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1508 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1509 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1510 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1511 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1512 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001513 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001514 used instead.
1515
1516 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1517 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1518 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1519 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1520
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001521 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1522 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1523 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1524
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001525 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001528 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1529 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001530
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001531 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001532 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001534 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1535 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1536 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001537
1538 Examples :
1539 balance roundrobin
1540 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001541 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001542 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1543 balance hdr(host)
1544 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001545
1546 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1547 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001549 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001550 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1551 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1552 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1553 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1554
1555 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1556 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1557 defaults to 16 kB.
1558
1559 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1560 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1561
1562 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1563 Round Robin.
1564
1565 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1566 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1567 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1568 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1569
1570 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1571
1572 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001573 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001574 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1575 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1576 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001578 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1579 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
1581
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001582bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1583bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1586 no | yes | yes | no
1587 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001588 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1589 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1590 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1591 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001592 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001593
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001594 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1595 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001596 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1597 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1598 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001599 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1600 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1601 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1602 the range.
1603
1604 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1605 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1606 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1607 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1608 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1609 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1610 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001611 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001612 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001614 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1615 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1616 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1617 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1618 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1619 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1620 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1621 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001623 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1624 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1625 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1626 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1629 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1630 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1631 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1632 in a frontend.
1633
1634 Example :
1635 listen http_proxy
1636 bind :80,:443
1637 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001638 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001640 listen http_https_proxy
1641 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001642 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001643
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001644 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001645 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
1647
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001648bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001649 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1651 yes | yes | yes | yes
1652 Arguments :
1653 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1654 may be used to override a default value.
1655
1656 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1657 option may be combined with other numbers.
1658
1659 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1660 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1661 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1662 missing from all processes.
1663
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001664 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1665 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1666 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1667 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1668 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001669
1670 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1671 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1672 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1673 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1674 and 'even' instances.
1675
1676 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1677 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1678 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1679 32.
1680
1681 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1682 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1683
1684 Example :
1685 listen app_ip1
1686 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001687 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001688
1689 listen app_ip2
1690 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001691 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001692
1693 listen management
1694 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001695 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001696
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001697 listen management
1698 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1699 bind-process 1-4
1700
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001701 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1702
1703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704block { if | unless } <condition>
1705 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1707 no | yes | yes | yes
1708
1709 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1710 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001711 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001712 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1714 "block" statements per instance.
1715
1716 Example:
1717 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1718 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1719 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1720 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001722 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001723
1724
1725capture cookie <name> len <length>
1726 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1728 no | yes | yes | no
1729 Arguments :
1730 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1731 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1732 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1733 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1734 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1735
1736 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1737 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1738 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1739 right if it exceeds <length>.
1740
1741 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1742 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1743 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1744 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1745
1746 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1747 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1748 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1749
1750 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1751 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1752 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001753 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1754 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1755 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001756
1757 Example:
1758 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1759
1760 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001761 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762
1763
1764capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001765 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1767 no | yes | yes | no
1768 Arguments :
1769 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001770 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1772 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1773 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1774
1775 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1776 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1777 it exceeds <length>.
1778
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001779 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1781 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001782 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1783 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1784 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1785 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001786 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001787 environments to find where the request came from.
1788
1789 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1790 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1791 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1792 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001794 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1795 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1796 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1797 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1798 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001799
1800 Example:
1801 capture request header Host len 15
1802 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1803 capture request header Referrer len 15
1804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001805 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806 about logging.
1807
1808
1809capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001810 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1812 no | yes | yes | no
1813 Arguments :
1814 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001815 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001816 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1817 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1818 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1819
1820 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1821 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1822 it exceeds <length>.
1823
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001824 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1826 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1827 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001828 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1829 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1830 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1831 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001833 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1834 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1835 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1836 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1837 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001838
1839 Example:
1840 capture response header Content-length len 9
1841 capture response header Location len 15
1842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001843 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 about logging.
1845
1846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001847clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1850 yes | yes | yes | no
1851 Arguments :
1852 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1854 as explained at the top of this document.
1855
1856 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1857 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1858 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1859 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1860 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1861 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1862 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1863 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001864 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001865 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1866 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1867
1868 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1870 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1871 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1872 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1873 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1874
1875 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1876 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1877
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001878 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1879 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001881compression algo <algorithm> ...
1882compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001883compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001884 Enable HTTP compression.
1885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1886 yes | yes | yes | yes
1887 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001888 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1889 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1890 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1891
1892 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001893 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001894 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1895 data.
1896
1897 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1898 support for zlib was built in.
1899
1900 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1901 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1902 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1903 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1904 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1905 in.
1906
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001907 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001908 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001909 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1910 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1911 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1912 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1913 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001914
1915 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1916 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1917 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1918 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1919 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001920 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1921 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1922 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1923 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1924 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1925 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001926
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001927 Compression is disabled when:
1928 * the server is not HTTP/1.1.
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001929 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001930 * requests does not contain Transfer-Encoding: chunked or Content-Length.
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001931 * Content-Type is multipart
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001932 * the request contains "Cache-control: no-transform".
1933 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" except MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7 and later.
1934 * The response is already compressed (see compression offload).
1935
1936 The compression does not rewrite Etag headers
1937
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001938 Examples :
1939 compression algo gzip
1940 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001942contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1945 yes | no | yes | yes
1946 Arguments :
1947 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1949 as explained at the top of this document.
1950
1951 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001952 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001953 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1955 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1956 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1957 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1958
1959 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1960 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1961 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1962 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1963 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1964 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1965
1966 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1967 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1968 instead.
1969
1970 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1971 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1972
1973
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001974cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001975 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1976 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1979 yes | no | yes | yes
1980 Arguments :
1981 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1982 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1983 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1984 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1985 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1986 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1987 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1988 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1989 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1990
1991 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1992 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1993 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1994 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1995 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1996 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1997 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1998 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1999 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2000 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2001 "insert" and "prefix".
2002
2003 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002004 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002005
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002006 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002007 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2008 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2009 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2010 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2011 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2012 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2013 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2014 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2015 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2016 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2019 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2020 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2021 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2022 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2023 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2024 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2025 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2026 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2027 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002028 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2029 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2030 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002032 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2033 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2034 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002035 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2036 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2037 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2038 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002039 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2040 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2041 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
2043 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2044 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2045 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2046 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2047 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2048 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2049 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2050 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2051 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2052
2053 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2054 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2055 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2056 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2057 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2058 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2059 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2060 persistence cookie in the cache.
2061 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2062
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002063 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2064 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2065 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2066 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2067 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2068 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2069 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2070 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2071 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2072 they logout.
2073
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002074 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2075 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2076 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2077 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2078
2079 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2080 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2081 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2082 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2083 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2084 this attribute.
2085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002086 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002087 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002088 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2089 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2090 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2091 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2092 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2093 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002094
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002095 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2096 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2097 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2098 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2099 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2100 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2101 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2102 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2103 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2104 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2105 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2106 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2107 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2108 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2109 the site.
2110
2111 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2112 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2113 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2114 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2115 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2116 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2117 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2118 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2119 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2120 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2121 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2122 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2123 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2124 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2125 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2126 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2129 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2130 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2131 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002133 Examples :
2134 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2135 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2136 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002137 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002138
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002139 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002140 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002143default-server [param*]
2144 Change default options for a server in a backend
2145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2146 yes | no | yes | yes
2147 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002148 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2149 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2150 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2151 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002152
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002153 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002154 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2155
2156 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159default_backend <backend>
2160 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2162 yes | yes | yes | no
2163 Arguments :
2164 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2165
2166 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2167 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2168 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2169 will catch all undetermined requests.
2170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 Example :
2172
2173 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2174 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2175 default_backend dynamic
2176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002177 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002179
2180disabled
2181 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | yes | yes | yes
2184 Arguments : none
2185
2186 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2187 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2188 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2189 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2190 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2191 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2192 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2193
2194 See also : "enabled"
2195
2196
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002197dispatch <address>:<port>
2198 Set a default server address
2199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2200 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002201 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002202
2203 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2204 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2205 during start-up.
2206
2207 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2208 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2209 possible with normal servers.
2210
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002211 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002212 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2213 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2214 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2215 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2216
2217 See also : "server"
2218
2219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002220enabled
2221 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 yes | yes | yes | yes
2224 Arguments : none
2225
2226 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2227 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2228
2229 See also : "disabled"
2230
2231
2232errorfile <code> <file>
2233 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | yes | yes | yes
2236 Arguments :
2237 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002238 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002239
2240 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002241 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002243 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2244 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
2246 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2247 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2248 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2249
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002250 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002252 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2253 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2254 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2255 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2256
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002257 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2258 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2259 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2260 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2261 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2262 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2265 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2266 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002267 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2269
2270 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2271
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002272 Example :
2273 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2274 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2275 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2276
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002277
2278errorloc <code> <url>
2279errorloc302 <code> <url>
2280 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2282 yes | yes | yes | yes
2283 Arguments :
2284 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002285 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002286
2287 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2288 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2289 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2290 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2291 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2292
2293 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2294 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2295 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2296
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002297 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2298
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002299 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2300 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2301 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2302 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2303 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2304 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2305 request.
2306
2307 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2308
2309
2310errorloc303 <code> <url>
2311 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2313 yes | yes | yes | yes
2314 Arguments :
2315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2316 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2317
2318 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2319 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2320 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2321 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2322 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2323
2324 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2325 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2326 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2327
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002328 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2329
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002330 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2331 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2332 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2333 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002334 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002335
2336 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2337
2338
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002339force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2340 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2342 no | yes | yes | yes
2343
2344 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2345 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2346 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2347 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2348 marked down for maintenance operations.
2349
2350 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2351 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2352 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2353 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2354 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2355 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2356 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2357 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2358 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2359
2360 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2361 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2362 is used.
2363
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002364 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002365 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002366
2367
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002368fullconn <conns>
2369 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2371 yes | no | yes | yes
2372 Arguments :
2373 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2374 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2375
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002376 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002377 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002378 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002379 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2380 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2381 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2382 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2383 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002384 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002385
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002386 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2387 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2388 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2389
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002390 Example :
2391 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2392 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2393 # connections.
2394 backend dynamic
2395 fullconn 10000
2396 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2397 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2398
2399 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2400
2401
2402grace <time>
2403 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002405 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002406 Arguments :
2407 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2408 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2409 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2410
2411 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2412 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002413 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002414 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2415
2416 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2417 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2418 simplify it.
2419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002420
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002421hash-type <method>
2422 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2424 yes | no | yes | yes
2425 Arguments :
2426 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2427 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2428 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2429 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2430 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2431 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2432 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2433 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2434 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2435
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002436 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2437 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2438 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2439 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2440 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2441 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2442 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2443 this value.
2444
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002445 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2446 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2447 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2448 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2449 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2450 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2451 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2452 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2453 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2454 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2455 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2456 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2457 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2458
2459 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2460
2461 See also : "balance", "server"
2462
2463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464http-check disable-on-404
2465 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002467 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 Arguments : none
2469
2470 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2471 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2472 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2473 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2474 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2475 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2476 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2477 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002478 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2479 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2480 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2481
2482 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2483
2484
2485http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002486 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002489 Arguments :
2490 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2491 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002492 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002493 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2494 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2495 details on the supported keywords.
2496
2497 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2498 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2499 with the usual backslash ('\').
2500
2501 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2502 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2503 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2504 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2505 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2506
2507 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002508 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002509 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2510 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2511 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2512
2513 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002514 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002515 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2516 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2517 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2518 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2519
2520 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002521 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002522 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2523 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2524 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2525 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2526 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2527 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2528 trace).
2529
2530 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002531 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002532 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2533 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2534 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2535 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2536 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2537 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2538
2539 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2540 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2541 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2542 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2543 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2544 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2545 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2546 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2547
2548 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2549 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2550
2551 Examples :
2552 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002553 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002554
2555 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002556 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002557
2558 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002559 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002560
2561 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002562 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002563
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002564 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002565
2566
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002567http-check send-state
2568 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 yes | no | yes | yes
2571 Arguments : none
2572
2573 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2574 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2575 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2576 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2577 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2578
2579 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2580 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2581 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2582 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2583 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2584 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2585 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2586 checked in multiple backends.
2587
2588 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2589 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2590
2591 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2592 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2593 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2594 one fails.
2595
2596 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2597 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2598 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2599
2600 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2601 server's queue.
2602
2603 Example of a header received by the application server :
2604 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2605 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2606
2607 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2608
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002609http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002610 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002611 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002612 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2613
2614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2615 no | yes | yes | yes
2616
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002617 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2618 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2619 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2620 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2621 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002622
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002623 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2624 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2625 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2626
2627 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2628 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2629 are evaluated.
2630
2631 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2632 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2633 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2634 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2635 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2636
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002637 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2638 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2639 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
2640 "http-request" rules. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
2641
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002642 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2643 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2644 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2645 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2646 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2647 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2648 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2649 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2650
2651 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2652 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2653 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2654 external users.
2655
2656 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2657
2658 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2659 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2660 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2661 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002662
2663 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002664 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2665 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2666 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002667
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002668 http-request allow if nagios
2669 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2670 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2671 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002672
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002673 Example:
2674 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002675 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002676
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002677 Example:
2678 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2679 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2684 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2685 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2686 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2687
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002688 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2689 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002690
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002691http-send-name-header [<header>]
2692 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2693
2694 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 yes | no | yes | yes
2696
2697 Arguments :
2698
2699 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2700
2701 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2702 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2703 is added with the header string proved.
2704
2705 See also : "server"
2706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002707id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002708 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2710 no | yes | yes | yes
2711 Arguments : none
2712
2713 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2714 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2715 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002716
2717
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002718ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2719 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2721 no | yes | yes | yes
2722
2723 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2724 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2725 and running).
2726
2727 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2728 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2729 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2730 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2731 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2732
2733 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2734 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2735
2736 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2737 "unless" condition is met.
2738
2739 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2740
2741
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002742log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002743log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002744no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002745 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2747 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002748
2749 Prefix :
2750 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2751 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2752 prefix does not allow arguments.
2753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002754 Arguments :
2755 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2756 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2757 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2758 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2759 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2760 parameter.
2761
2762 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2763 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2764
2765 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2766 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2767 standard syslog port).
2768
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002769 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2770 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2771 standard syslog port).
2772
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002773 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2774 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2775 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2776 appropriately writeable).
2777
2778 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2779
2780 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2781 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2782 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2783
2784 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2785 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2786 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002787 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2788 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2789 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2790 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2791 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002792
2793 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2794
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002795 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2796 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2797 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002798
2799 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2800 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2801 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2802 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2803
2804 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2805 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002806
2807 Example :
2808 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002809 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2810 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002811
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002812log-format <string>
2813 Allows you to custom a log line.
2814
2815 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002817
2818maxconn <conns>
2819 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2821 yes | yes | yes | no
2822 Arguments :
2823 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2824 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2825 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2826 closes.
2827
2828 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2829 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2830 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2831 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2832 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2833 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2834 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2835 properly tuned.
2836
2837 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2838 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2839 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2840
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002841 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2842
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002843 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2844
2845
2846mode { tcp|http|health }
2847 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 yes | yes | yes | yes
2850 Arguments :
2851 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2852 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2853 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2854 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2855
2856 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2857 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2858 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2859 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2860 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2861
2862 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002863 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2864 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2865 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2866 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2867 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2868 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2869 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002871 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2872 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2873 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002874
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002875 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002876 defaults http_instances
2877 mode http
2878
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002879 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002882monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002883 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2885 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Arguments :
2887 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2888 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002889 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002890 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2891 backend and its backup.
2892
2893 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2894 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2895 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2896 servers in a list of backends.
2897
2898 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2899 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2900 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2901 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2902 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2903 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2904 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002905 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2906 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002907
2908 Example:
2909 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002910 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002911 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2912 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2913 monitor-uri /site_alive
2914 monitor fail if site_dead
2915
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002916 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002917
2918
2919monitor-net <source>
2920 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2922 yes | yes | yes | no
2923 Arguments :
2924 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2925 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2926 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2927 followed by a mask.
2928
2929 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2930 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002931 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002932 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2933
2934 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2935 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2936 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2937 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002938 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2939 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2940 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002941
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002942 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2943 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2944 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2945 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2946 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2947 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002948
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002949 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2950 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002951
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002952 Example :
2953 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2954 frontend www
2955 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2956
2957 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2958
2959
2960monitor-uri <uri>
2961 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2963 yes | yes | yes | no
2964 Arguments :
2965 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2966 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2967
2968 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2969 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2970 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2971 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2972 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2973 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2974 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2975 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2976
2977 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2978 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2979 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2980 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2981 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2982 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2983
2984 Example :
2985 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2986 frontend www
2987 mode http
2988 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2989
2990 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002993option abortonclose
2994no option abortonclose
2995 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | no | yes | yes
2998 Arguments : none
2999
3000 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3001 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3002 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3003 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003004 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003005 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3006 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3007 encountered while delivering the response.
3008
3009 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3010 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3011 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3012 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3013 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3014 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003015 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003016 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003017 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3019 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3020 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3021
3022 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3023 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3024 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3025 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3026 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3027 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3028 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3029 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003030 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003031
3032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3034
3035 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3036
3037
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003038option accept-invalid-http-request
3039no option accept-invalid-http-request
3040 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3042 yes | yes | yes | no
3043 Arguments : none
3044
3045 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3046 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3047 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3048 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3049 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3050 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3051 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3052 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003053 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3054 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3055 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3056 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3057 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3058 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003059
3060 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3061 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3062 been confirmed.
3063
3064 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3065 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003066 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3067 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003068 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3069
3070 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3071 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3072
3073 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3074 stats socket.
3075
3076
3077option accept-invalid-http-response
3078no option accept-invalid-http-response
3079 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3081 yes | no | yes | yes
3082 Arguments : none
3083
3084 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3085 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3086 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3087 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3088 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3089 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3090 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3091 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3092 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3093
3094 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3095 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3096 been confirmed.
3097
3098 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3099 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3100 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3101 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3102
3103 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3104 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3105
3106 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3107 stats socket.
3108
3109
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003110option allbackups
3111no option allbackups
3112 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3114 yes | no | yes | yes
3115 Arguments : none
3116
3117 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3118 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3119 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3120 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3121 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3122 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3123 order between the backup servers anymore.
3124
3125 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3126 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3127
3128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3130
3131
3132option checkcache
3133no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003134 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 yes | no | yes | yes
3137 Arguments : none
3138
3139 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3140 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003141 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003142 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3143 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003144 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003145
3146 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003147 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003148 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003149 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3150 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003151 to the client are :
3152 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003153 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003154 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003155 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3156 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3157 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3158 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3159 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3160 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3161 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3162 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3163 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3165 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3166
3167 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003168 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003169 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003170 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003171 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3172
3173 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3174 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003175 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003176 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3177
3178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3180
3181
3182option clitcpka
3183no option clitcpka
3184 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3186 yes | yes | yes | no
3187 Arguments : none
3188
3189 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3190 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3191 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3192 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3193
3194 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3195 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3196 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3197 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3198
3199 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3200 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3201 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3202 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3203 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3204
3205 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3206
3207 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3208 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3209 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3210
3211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3213
3214 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3215
3216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217option contstats
3218 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3220 yes | yes | yes | no
3221 Arguments : none
3222
3223 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3224 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3225 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3226 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3227 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3228 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3229 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3230
3231
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003232option dontlog-normal
3233no option dontlog-normal
3234 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | yes | yes | no
3237 Arguments : none
3238
3239 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3240 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3241 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3242 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3243 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3244 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3245 logged.
3246
3247 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3248 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3249 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003251 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003252 logging.
3253
3254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003255option dontlognull
3256no option dontlognull
3257 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | yes | yes | no
3260 Arguments : none
3261
3262 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3263 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3264 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3265 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3266 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3267 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3268 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3269
3270 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3271 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3272 would not be logged.
3273
3274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003277 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003278
3279
3280option forceclose
3281no option forceclose
3282 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003284 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003285 Arguments : none
3286
3287 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3288 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3289 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3290 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3291 global session times in the logs.
3292
3293 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003294 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003295 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3296 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3297 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3298 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003299
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003300 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3301 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3302 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3303
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003304 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3305 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3306
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003307 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003308
3309
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003310option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003311 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | yes | yes | yes
3314 Arguments :
3315 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3316 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003317 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003318 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003319
3320 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3321 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3322 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3323 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3324 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3325 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3326 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003327 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3328 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3329 possible that the client has already brought one.
3330
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003331 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003332 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003333 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3334 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003335 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3336 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003337
3338 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3339 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3340 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3341 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3342 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3343 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3344 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3345
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003346 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3347 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3348 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3349 are under the control of the end-user.
3350
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003351 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003352 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3353 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003354 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3355 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3356 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003357
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003358 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3359 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3360 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3361 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3362 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003363
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003364 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003365 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3366 frontend www
3367 mode http
3368 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3369
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003370 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3371 backend www
3372 mode http
3373 option forwardfor header X-Client
3374
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003375 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3376 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003377
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003378
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003379option http-no-delay
3380no option http-no-delay
3381 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 yes | yes | yes | yes
3384 Arguments : none
3385
3386 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3387 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3388 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3389 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3390 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3391 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3392 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3393 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3394 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3395 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3396 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3397 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3398 affected.
3399
3400 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3401 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3402 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3403 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3404 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3405 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3406 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3407 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3408 latency environments.
3409
3410
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003411option http-pretend-keepalive
3412no option http-pretend-keepalive
3413 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3415 yes | yes | yes | yes
3416 Arguments : none
3417
3418 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3419 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3420 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3421 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3422 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3423 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3424 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3425 consider the response complete.
3426
3427 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3428 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3429 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3430 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3431 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3432 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3433
3434 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3435 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3436 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3437 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3438 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3439 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3440 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3441
3442 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3443 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003444 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003445 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3446 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003447
3448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3450
3451 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3452
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003453
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003454option http-server-close
3455no option http-server-close
3456 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3458 yes | yes | yes | yes
3459 Arguments : none
3460
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003461 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3462 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3463 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3464 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3465 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3466 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3467 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3468 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3469 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3470 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3471 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3472 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003473
3474 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3475 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3476 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3477 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003478 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3479 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003480
3481 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3482 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003483 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3484 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3485 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003486
3487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3489
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003490 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3491 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003492
3493
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003494option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003495no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003496 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 yes | yes | yes | no
3499 Arguments : none
3500
3501 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3502 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3503 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3504 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3505 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3506 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3507 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3508
3509 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3510 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3511 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3512 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3513 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3514 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3515 request along its whole life.
3516
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003517 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3518 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3519 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3520 front of an existing proxy.
3521
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003522 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3523
3524 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3525 http-server-close".
3526
3527
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003528option httpchk
3529option httpchk <uri>
3530option httpchk <method> <uri>
3531option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3532 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3534 yes | no | yes | yes
3535 Arguments :
3536 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3537 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3538 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3539 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3540 ones.
3541
3542 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3543 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3544 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3545
3546 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3547 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3548 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3549 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3550 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3551
3552 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3553 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3554 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3555 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3556 the lack of any response.
3557
3558 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3559
3560 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3561 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3562 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3563
3564 Examples :
3565 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3566 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3567 backend https_relay
3568 mode tcp
3569 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3570 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3571
3572 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003573 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3574 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003575
3576
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577option httpclose
3578no option httpclose
3579 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 yes | yes | yes | yes
3582 Arguments : none
3583
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003584 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3585 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3586 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3587 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3588 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3589 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3590 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003591
3592 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003593 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003594 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3595 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3596 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3597 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3598 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003599
3600 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3601 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3602 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003603 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3604 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003605
3606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3608
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003609 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3610 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003611
3612
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003613option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003614 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003617 Arguments :
3618 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3619 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3620 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3621 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3622 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003623
3624 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3625 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3626 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3627 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3628 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3629 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3630 ports.
3631
3632 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3633
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003634 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3635 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3636 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3637 by default.
3638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003639 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003640
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003641
3642option http_proxy
3643no option http_proxy
3644 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | yes | yes | yes
3647 Arguments : none
3648
3649 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3650 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3651 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3652 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3653 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3654
3655 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3656 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3657 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3658 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003659 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003660 be analyzed.
3661
3662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3664
3665 Example :
3666 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3667 backend direct_forward
3668 option httpclose
3669 option http_proxy
3670
3671 See also : "option httpclose"
3672
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003673
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003674option independent-streams
3675no option independent-streams
3676 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3678 yes | yes | yes | yes
3679 Arguments : none
3680
3681 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3682 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3683 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3684 receive data or not.
3685
3686 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3687 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3688 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3689 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3690 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3691 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3692 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3693 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3694 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3695 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3696 socket buffers.
3697
3698 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3699 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3700 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3701 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3702 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3703
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003704 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3705 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3706 deprecated.
3707
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003708 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003709
3710
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003711option ldap-check
3712 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | no | yes | yes
3715 Arguments : none
3716
3717 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3718 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3719 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3720 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3721
3722 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3723 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3724
3725 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3726 configure it.
3727
3728 Example :
3729 option ldap-check
3730
3731 See also : "option httpchk"
3732
3733
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003734option log-health-checks
3735no option log-health-checks
3736 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3738 yes | no | yes | yes
3739 Arguments : none
3740
3741 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3742 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3743 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3744 of additional information is limited.
3745
3746 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3747 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3748
3749 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3750
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003751
3752option log-separate-errors
3753no option log-separate-errors
3754 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | no
3757 Arguments : none
3758
3759 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3760 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3761 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3762 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3763 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3764 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3765 provides very important information.
3766
3767 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3768 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3769 error logs.
3770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003771 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003772 logging.
3773
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003774
3775option logasap
3776no option logasap
3777 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | no
3780 Arguments : none
3781
3782 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3783 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3784 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3785 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3786 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3787 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3788 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003789 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003790 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3791 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3792
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003793 Examples :
3794 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3795 mode http
3796 option httplog
3797 option logasap
3798 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3799
3800 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3801 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3802 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3803 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003805 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003806 logging.
3807
3808
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003809option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3810 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003813 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003814 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3815 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003816
3817 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3818 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3819 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3820 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3821 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3822 in the MySQL table, like this :
3823
3824 USE mysql;
3825 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3826 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3827
3828 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3829 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3830 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3831 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3832 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3833 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3834 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3835 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3836 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3837
3838 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3839 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003840
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003841 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003842
3843 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3844 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3845 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3846 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3847 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3848 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3849
3850 See also: "option httpchk"
3851
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003852option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3853 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 yes | no | yes | yes
3856 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003857 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3858 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003859
3860 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3861 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3862 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3863 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3864
3865 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003866
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003867option nolinger
3868no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003869 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003872 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003873
3874 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3875 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3876 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3877 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3878 connections.
3879
3880 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3881 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3882 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3883 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3884 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3885 this too.
3886
3887 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3888 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3889 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3890
3891 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3892 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3893 for servers.
3894
3895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3897
3898
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003899option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3900 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | yes | yes | yes
3903 Arguments :
3904 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3905 matching <network>
3906 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3907 header name.
3908
3909 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3910 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3911 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3912 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3913 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3914 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3915 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3916 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3917 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3918 possible that the client has already brought one.
3919
3920 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3921 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3922 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3923 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3924 header and requires different one.
3925
3926 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3927 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3928 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3929 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3930 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3931 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3932 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3933
3934 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3935 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3936 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3937 both are defined.
3938
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003939 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3940 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3941 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3942 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3943 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003944
3945 Examples :
3946 # Original Destination address
3947 frontend www
3948 mode http
3949 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3950
3951 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3952 backend www
3953 mode http
3954 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3955
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003956 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3957 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003958
3959
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003960option persist
3961no option persist
3962 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3964 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003965 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003966
3967 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3968 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3969 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3970 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3971 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3972 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3973 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3974 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3975 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3976 redirected to another valid server.
3977
3978 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3979 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3980
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003981 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003982
3983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003984option redispatch
3985no option redispatch
3986 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3988 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003989 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003990
3991 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3992 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3993 be able to access the service anymore.
3994
3995 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3996 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3997
3998 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3999 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4000 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004002 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4003 "redisp" keywords.
4004
4005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4007
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004008 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004009
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004010
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004011option redis-check
4012 Use redis health checks for server testing
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | no | yes | yes
4015 Arguments : none
4016
4017 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4018 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4019 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4020 find the "+PONG" response message.
4021
4022 Example :
4023 option redis-check
4024
4025 See also : "option httpchk"
4026
4027
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004028option smtpchk
4029option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4030 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4032 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004033 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004034 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4035 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4036 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4037
4038 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4039 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4040 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4041
4042 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4043 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4044 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4045 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4046 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4047 dead server.
4048
4049 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4050 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4051 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4052 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4053
4054 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4055 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4056 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4057 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4058 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4059
4060 Example :
4061 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4062
4063 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004066option socket-stats
4067no option socket-stats
4068
4069 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | yes | yes | no
4072
4073 Arguments : none
4074
4075
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004076option splice-auto
4077no option splice-auto
4078 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4080 yes | yes | yes | yes
4081 Arguments : none
4082
4083 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4084 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4085 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4086 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004087 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004088 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4089 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4090 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4091 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4092
4093 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4094 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4095 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4096 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4097 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4098 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4099 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4100 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4101 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4102 keyword.
4103
4104 Example :
4105 option splice-auto
4106
4107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4109
4110 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4111 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4112
4113
4114option splice-request
4115no option splice-request
4116 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | yes | yes | yes
4119 Arguments : none
4120
4121 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004122 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004123 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4124 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4125 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4126 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4127
4128 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4129
4130 Example :
4131 option splice-request
4132
4133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4135
4136 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4137 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4138
4139
4140option splice-response
4141no option splice-response
4142 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4144 yes | yes | yes | yes
4145 Arguments : none
4146
4147 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004148 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004149 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4150 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4151 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4152 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4153
4154 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4155
4156 Example :
4157 option splice-response
4158
4159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4161
4162 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4163 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4164
4165
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004166option srvtcpka
4167no option srvtcpka
4168 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | no | yes | yes
4171 Arguments : none
4172
4173 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4174 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4175 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4176 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4177
4178 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4179 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4180 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4181 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4182
4183 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4184 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4185 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4186 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4187 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4188
4189 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4190
4191 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4192 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4193 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4194
4195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4197
4198 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4199
4200
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004201option ssl-hello-chk
4202 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 yes | no | yes | yes
4205 Arguments : none
4206
4207 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4208 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4209 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4210 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4211 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4212 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4213 hello message.
4214
4215 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4216 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4217 messages, which is appreciable.
4218
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004219 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4220 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4221 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004222
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004223 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4224
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004225
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004226option tcp-smart-accept
4227no option tcp-smart-accept
4228 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4230 yes | yes | yes | no
4231 Arguments : none
4232
4233 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4234 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4235 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4236 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4237 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4238 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4239
4240 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4241 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4242 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4243 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4244
4245 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4246 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4247 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4248 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4249
4250 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4251 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4252 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4253
4254 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4255 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4256 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4257
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004258 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4259
4260
4261option tcp-smart-connect
4262no option tcp-smart-connect
4263 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4265 yes | no | yes | yes
4266 Arguments : none
4267
4268 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4269 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4270 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4271 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4272 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4273
4274 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4275 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4276 complex.
4277
4278 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4279 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4280 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4281
4282 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4283 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4284
4285 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4286
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004287
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004288option tcpka
4289 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 yes | yes | yes | yes
4292 Arguments : none
4293
4294 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4295 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4296 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4297 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4298
4299 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4300 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4301 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4302 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4303
4304 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4305 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4306 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4307 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4308 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4309
4310 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4311
4312 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4313 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4314 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4315 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4316 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4317 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4318 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4319 backends.
4320
4321 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4322
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004323
4324option tcplog
4325 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | yes | yes | yes
4328 Arguments : none
4329
4330 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4331 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4332 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4333 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4334 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4335 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4336 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4337 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4338
4339 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004341 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004342
4343
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004344option transparent
4345no option transparent
4346 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004348 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004349 Arguments : none
4350
4351 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4352 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4353 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4354 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4355 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4356 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4357 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4358 appropriate server.
4359
4360 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4361 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4362
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004363 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004364 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004365
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004366
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004367persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004368persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004369 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 yes | no | yes | yes
4372 Arguments :
4373 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004374 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4375 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004376
4377 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4378 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4379 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4380 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4381 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4382 forwarded to this server.
4383
4384 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4385 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4386 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004387 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004388 a single "listen" section.
4389
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004390 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4391 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4392 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4393
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004394 Example :
4395 listen tse-farm
4396 bind :3389
4397 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4398 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4399 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4400 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4401 persist rdp-cookie
4402 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004403 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004404 balance rdp-cookie
4405 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4406 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4407
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004408 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4409 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004410
4411
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004412rate-limit sessions <rate>
4413 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4415 yes | yes | yes | no
4416 Arguments :
4417 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4418 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4419
4420 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4421 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4422 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4423 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4424 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4425 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4426
4427 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4428 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4429 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4430 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4431
4432 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4433 listen smtp
4434 mode tcp
4435 bind :25
4436 rate-limit sessions 10
4437 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4438
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004439 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4440 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4441 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004442
4443 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4444
4445
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004446redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4447redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4448redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004449 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 no | yes | yes | yes
4452
4453 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004454 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004455
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004456 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004457 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4458 the HTTP "Location" header.
4459
4460 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4461 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4462 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4463 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4464 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4465 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4466
4467 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4468 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4469 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4470 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4471 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4472 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4473 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4474 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4475 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004476
4477 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4478 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4479 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4480 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4481 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4482 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4483 location with a GET method.
4484
4485 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4486 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4487
4488 - "drop-query"
4489 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4490 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4491 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4492 with a location-type redirect.
4493
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004494 - "append-slash"
4495 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4496 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4497 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4498 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4499
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004500 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4501 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4502 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4503 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4504 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4505 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4506 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4507
4508 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4509 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4510 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4511 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4512 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4513 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4514 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004515
4516 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4517 acl clear dst_port 80
4518 acl secure dst_port 8080
4519 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004520 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004521 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004522 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4523
4524 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004525 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4526 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4527 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004528 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004529
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004530 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4531 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4532 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4533
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004534 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004535 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004537 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004538
4539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004540redisp (deprecated)
4541redispatch (deprecated)
4542 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004545 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004546
4547 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4548 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4549 be able to access the service anymore.
4550
4551 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4552 redistribute them to a working server.
4553
4554 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4555 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4556 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004558 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4559 "option redispatch" instead.
4560
4561 See also : "option redispatch"
4562
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004563
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004564reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004565 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4567 no | yes | yes | yes
4568 Arguments :
4569 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4570 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004571 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004572
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004573 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4574 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4575
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004576 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4577 the last header of an HTTP request.
4578
4579 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4580 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4581 responses.
4582
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004583 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4584 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4585 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4586
4587 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4588 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004589
4590
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004591reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4592reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004593 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 no | yes | yes | yes
4596 Arguments :
4597 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4598 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4599 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4600 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4601 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4602 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4603 ignores case.
4604
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004605 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4606 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4607
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4609 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4610 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4611 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004612 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004613
4614 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4615 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4616
4617 Example :
4618 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4619 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4620 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4621
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004622 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4623 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004624
4625
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004626reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4627reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004628 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4630 no | yes | yes | yes
4631 Arguments :
4632 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4633 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4634 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4635 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4636 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4637 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4638
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004639 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4640 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4641
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004642 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4643 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4644 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4645 next servers.
4646
4647 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4648 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4649 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4650
4651 Example :
4652 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4653 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4654 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4655
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004656 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4657 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004658
4659
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004660reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4661reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004662 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 no | yes | yes | yes
4665 Arguments :
4666 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4667 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4668 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4669 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4670 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4671 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4672 case.
4673
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004674 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4675 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4676
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004677 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4678 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4679 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4680 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004681 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004683 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004684 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004685 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004686
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004687 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4688 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4689
4690 Example :
4691 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4692 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4693 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004695 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4696 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004697
4698
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004699reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4700reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004701 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 no | yes | yes | yes
4704 Arguments :
4705 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4706 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4707 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4708 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4709 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4710 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4711 case.
4712
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004713 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4714 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4715
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004716 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4717 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4718 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4719 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4720
4721 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4722 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4723
4724 Example :
4725 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4726 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4727 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4728 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004730 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4731 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004732
4733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004734reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4735reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004736 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4738 no | yes | yes | yes
4739 Arguments :
4740 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4741 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4742 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4743 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4744 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4745 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4746
4747 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4748 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4749 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4750 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004751 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004752
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004753 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4754 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4755
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004756 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4757 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4758 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4759
4760 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4761 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4762 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4763 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4764 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4765
4766 Example :
4767 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004768 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004769 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4770 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4771
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004772 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4773 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004774
4775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004776reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4777reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004778 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4780 no | yes | yes | yes
4781 Arguments :
4782 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4783 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4784 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4785 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4786 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4787 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4788 ignores case.
4789
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004790 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4791 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4792
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004793 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4794 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004795 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4796 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4797 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004798 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4799 not set.
4800
4801 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4802 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4803 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4804 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4805 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4806
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004807 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004808 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4809 # block all others.
4810 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4811 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4812
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004813 # block bad guys
4814 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4815 reqitarpit . if badguys
4816
4817 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4818 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004819
4820
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004821retries <value>
4822 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | no | yes | yes
4825 Arguments :
4826 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4827 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4828 default value is 3.
4829
4830 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4831 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4832 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4833
4834 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4835 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4836
4837 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4838 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4839
4840 See also : "option redispatch"
4841
4842
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004843rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004844 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 no | yes | yes | yes
4847 Arguments :
4848 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4849 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004850 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004851
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004852 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4853 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4854
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004855 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4856 the last header of an HTTP response.
4857
4858 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4859 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4860 responses.
4861
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004862 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4863 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004864
4865
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004866rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4867rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004868 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 no | yes | yes | yes
4871 Arguments :
4872 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4873 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4874 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4875 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4876 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4877 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4878 ignores case.
4879
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004880 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4881 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4882
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004883 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4884 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004885 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004886 client.
4887
4888 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4889 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4890 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4891
4892 Example :
4893 # remove the Server header from responses
4894 reqidel ^Server:.*
4895
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004896 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4897 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004898
4899
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004900rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4901rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004902 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 no | yes | yes | yes
4905 Arguments :
4906 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4907 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4908 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4909 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4910 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4911 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4912 ignores case.
4913
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004914 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4915 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4916
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004917 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4918 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4919 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4920 case-sensitive.
4921
4922 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004923 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4924 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4925 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004926
4927 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4928 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4929
4930 Example :
4931 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4932 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4933
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004934 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4935 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004936
4937
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004938rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4939rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004940 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4942 no | yes | yes | yes
4943 Arguments :
4944 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4945 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4946 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4947 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4948 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4949 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4950 ignores case.
4951
4952 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4953 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4954 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4955 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004956 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004957
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004958 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4959 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4960
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004961 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4962 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4963 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4964
4965 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4966 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4967 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4968 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4969 are not case-sensitive.
4970
4971 Example :
4972 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4973 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4974
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004975 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4976 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004977
4978
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004979server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004980 Declare a server in a backend
4981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 no | no | yes | yes
4983 Arguments :
4984 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004985 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004986 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004987
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004988 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4989 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4990 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4991 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004992 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4993 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4994 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4995 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4996 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4997 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004999 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005000 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5001 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5002 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5003 adding this value to the client's port.
5004
5005 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5006 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005007 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005008
5009 Examples :
5010 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5011 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
5012
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005013 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5014 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005015
5016
5017source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005018source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005019source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005020 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | no | yes | yes
5023 Arguments :
5024 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5025 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
5026 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
5027 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
5028
5029 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5030 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005031 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5032 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5033 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005034
5035 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5036 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5037 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5038 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5039 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5040 <addr>.
5041
5042 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5043 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5044 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5045 port.
5046
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005047 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5048 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5049 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5050 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
5051 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
5052 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5053 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5054 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5055 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5056 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5057 HTTP header.
5058
5059 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5060 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005061 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005062 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5063 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5064 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5065 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5066 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5067 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5068 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5069
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005070 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5071 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5072 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5073 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5074 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5075 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5076
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005077 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5078 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5079 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5080 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5081
5082 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5083 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5084 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5085 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5086 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5087 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5088
5089 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5090 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5091 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5092 there are two methods :
5093
5094 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5095 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5096 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5097 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5098 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5099 of the client ranges may be used.
5100
5101 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5102 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5103 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5104 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5105 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5106 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5107 same session.
5108
5109 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5110 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5111 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5112 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5113 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5114 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5115
5116 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5117 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5118 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005119 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005120
5121 Examples :
5122 backend private
5123 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5124 source 192.168.1.200
5125
5126 backend transparent_ssl1
5127 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5128 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5129
5130 backend transparent_ssl2
5131 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5132 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5133 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5134
5135 backend transparent_ssl3
5136 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5137 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5138 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5139
5140 backend transparent_smtp
5141 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5142 # with Tproxy version 4.
5143 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5144
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005145 backend transparent_http
5146 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5147 # proxy.
5148 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005150 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005151 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005153
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005154srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5155 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | no | yes | yes
5158 Arguments :
5159 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5160 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5161 as explained at the top of this document.
5162
5163 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5164 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5165 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5166 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5167 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5168 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5169 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5170
5171 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5172 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5173 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5174 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5175 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005176 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005177 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005178 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005179
5180 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5181 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5182 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5183 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5184 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5185 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5186
5187 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5188 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5189
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005190 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5191 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005192
5193
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005194stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5195 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5197 no | no | yes | yes
5198
5199 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5200 matched.
5201
5202 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5203 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005205 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5206 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5207 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5208
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005209 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5210 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5211 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5212 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005213
5214 Example :
5215 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5216 backend stats_localhost
5217 stats enable
5218 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5219
5220 Example :
5221 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5222 backend stats_auth
5223 stats enable
5224 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5225 stats admin if TRUE
5226
5227 Example :
5228 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5229 userlist stats-auth
5230 group admin users admin
5231 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5232 group readonly users haproxy
5233 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5234
5235 backend stats_auth
5236 stats enable
5237 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5238 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5239 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5240 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5241
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005242 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5243 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5244 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005245
5246
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005247stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5248 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5250 yes | no | yes | yes
5251 Arguments :
5252 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5253
5254 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5255
5256 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5257 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5258 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5259 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5260 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5261 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5262
5263 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5264 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5265 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005266 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005267
5268 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5269 report using "stats scope".
5270
5271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5273 unobvious parameters.
5274
5275 Example :
5276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5277 backend public_www
5278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5279 stats enable
5280 stats hide-version
5281 stats scope .
5282 stats uri /admin?stats
5283 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5286
5287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5288 backend private_monitoring
5289 stats enable
5290 stats uri /admin?stats
5291 stats refresh 5s
5292
5293 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5294
5295
5296stats enable
5297 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | no | yes | yes
5300 Arguments : none
5301
5302 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5303 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5304 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5305 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5306 - stats auth : no authentication
5307 - stats scope : no restriction
5308
5309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5311 unobvious parameters.
5312
5313 Example :
5314 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5315 backend public_www
5316 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5317 stats enable
5318 stats hide-version
5319 stats scope .
5320 stats uri /admin?stats
5321 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5322 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5323 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5324
5325 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5326 backend private_monitoring
5327 stats enable
5328 stats uri /admin?stats
5329 stats refresh 5s
5330
5331 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5332
5333
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005334stats hide-version
5335 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005338 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005339
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005340 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5341 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5342 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5343 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5344 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5345 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005347 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5348 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5349 unobvious parameters.
5350
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005351 Example :
5352 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5353 backend public_www
5354 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005355 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005356 stats hide-version
5357 stats scope .
5358 stats uri /admin?stats
5359 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5360 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5361 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005362
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005363 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5364 backend private_monitoring
5365 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005366 stats uri /admin?stats
5367 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005368
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005369 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005370
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005371
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005372stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5373 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5374 Access control for statistics
5375
5376 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 no | no | yes | yes
5378
5379 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5380 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5381 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5382 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5383 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5384 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5385
5386 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5387 instance.
5388
5389 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5390 about ACL usage.
5391
5392
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005393stats realm <realm>
5394 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | no | yes | yes
5397 Arguments :
5398 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5399 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5400 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5401
5402 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5403 using a backslash ('\').
5404
5405 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5406 only related to authentication.
5407
5408 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5409 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5410 unobvious parameters.
5411
5412 Example :
5413 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5414 backend public_www
5415 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5416 stats enable
5417 stats hide-version
5418 stats scope .
5419 stats uri /admin?stats
5420 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5421 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5422 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5423
5424 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5425 backend private_monitoring
5426 stats enable
5427 stats uri /admin?stats
5428 stats refresh 5s
5429
5430 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5431
5432
5433stats refresh <delay>
5434 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | no | yes | yes
5437 Arguments :
5438 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5439 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5440 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5441 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5442 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5443 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5444
5445 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5446 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5447 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5448 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5449
5450 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5451 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5452 unobvious parameters.
5453
5454 Example :
5455 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5456 backend public_www
5457 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5458 stats enable
5459 stats hide-version
5460 stats scope .
5461 stats uri /admin?stats
5462 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5463 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5464 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5465
5466 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5467 backend private_monitoring
5468 stats enable
5469 stats uri /admin?stats
5470 stats refresh 5s
5471
5472 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5473
5474
5475stats scope { <name> | "." }
5476 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 yes | no | yes | yes
5479 Arguments :
5480 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5481 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5482 section in which the statement appears.
5483
5484 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5485 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5486 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5487 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5488 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5489 exists.
5490
5491 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5492 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5493 unobvious parameters.
5494
5495 Example :
5496 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5497 backend public_www
5498 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5499 stats enable
5500 stats hide-version
5501 stats scope .
5502 stats uri /admin?stats
5503 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5504 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5505 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5506
5507 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5508 backend private_monitoring
5509 stats enable
5510 stats uri /admin?stats
5511 stats refresh 5s
5512
5513 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5514
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005515
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005516stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005517 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 yes | no | yes | yes
5520
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005521 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005522 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5523
5524 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5525 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5526
5527 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5528 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005529 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005530
5531 Example :
5532 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5533 backend private_monitoring
5534 stats enable
5535 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5536 stats uri /admin?stats
5537 stats refresh 5s
5538
5539 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5540 global section.
5541
5542
5543stats show-legends
5544 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5545 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5546 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5547 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5548 - IP (socket, server)
5549 - cookie (backend, server)
5550
5551 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5552 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005553 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005554
5555 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5556
5557
5558stats show-node [ <name> ]
5559 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5561 yes | no | yes | yes
5562 Arguments:
5563 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5564 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5565
5566 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5567 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005568 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005569
5570 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5571 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5572 unobvious parameters.
5573
5574 Example:
5575 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5576 backend private_monitoring
5577 stats enable
5578 stats show-node Europe-1
5579 stats uri /admin?stats
5580 stats refresh 5s
5581
5582 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5583 section.
5584
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005585
5586stats uri <prefix>
5587 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 yes | no | yes | yes
5590 Arguments :
5591 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5592 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5593 query string.
5594
5595 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5596 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5597 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5598 possible to reach it in the application.
5599
5600 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005601 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005602 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5603 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5604 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5605 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5606
5607 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5608 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5609 an address or a port to statistics only.
5610
5611 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5612 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5613 unobvious parameters.
5614
5615 Example :
5616 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5617 backend public_www
5618 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5619 stats enable
5620 stats hide-version
5621 stats scope .
5622 stats uri /admin?stats
5623 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5624 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5625 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5626
5627 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5628 backend private_monitoring
5629 stats enable
5630 stats uri /admin?stats
5631 stats refresh 5s
5632
5633 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5634
5635
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005636stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5637 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005639 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005640
5641 Arguments :
5642 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5643 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5644 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5645 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5646
5647 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5648 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5649 the "stick-table" statement.
5650
5651 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5652 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5653 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5654 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5655 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5656
5657 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5658 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5659 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5660 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5661 transformation rules.
5662
5663 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5664 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5665 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5666 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5667 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5668 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5669 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5670
5671 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5672 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5673 ACL based conditions.
5674
5675 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5676 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5677 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5678 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5679
5680 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5681 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5682 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5683 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5684
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005685 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5686 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5687 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5688
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005689 Example :
5690 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5691 # last 30 minutes
5692 backend pop
5693 mode tcp
5694 balance roundrobin
5695 stick store-request src
5696 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5697 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5698 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5699
5700 backend smtp
5701 mode tcp
5702 balance roundrobin
5703 stick match src table pop
5704 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5705 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5706
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005707 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5708 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005709
5710
5711stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5712 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5714 no | no | yes | yes
5715
5716 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5717 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5718 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5719 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5720
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005721 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5722 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5723 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5724
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005725 Examples :
5726 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005727 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005728
5729 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5730 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5731 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5732
5733
5734 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5735 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5736 backend http
5737 mode http
5738 balance roundrobin
5739 stick on src table https
5740 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5741 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5742 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5743
5744 backend https
5745 mode tcp
5746 balance roundrobin
5747 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5748 stick on src
5749 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5750 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5751
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005752 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005753
5754
5755stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5756 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5758 no | no | yes | yes
5759
5760 Arguments :
5761 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5762 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5763 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5764 server is selected.
5765
5766 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5767 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5768 the "stick-table" statement.
5769
5770 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5771 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5772 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5773 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5774 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5775 address.
5776
5777 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5778 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5779 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5780 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5781 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5782 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5783 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5784 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5785 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5786 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5787
5788 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5789 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5790 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5791 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5792 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5793 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5794 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5795
5796 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5797 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5798 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5799 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5800
5801 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5802 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5803 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5804 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5805 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5806 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5807 another protocol or access method.
5808
5809 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5810 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5811 the request.
5812
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005813 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5814 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5815 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5816
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005817 Example :
5818 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5819 # last 30 minutes
5820 backend pop
5821 mode tcp
5822 balance roundrobin
5823 stick store-request src
5824 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5825 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5826 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5827
5828 backend smtp
5829 mode tcp
5830 balance roundrobin
5831 stick match src table pop
5832 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5833 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5834
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005835 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5836 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005837
5838
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005839stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005840 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5841 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005842 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005844 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005845
5846 Arguments :
5847 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5848 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5849 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5850 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5851
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005852 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5853 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5854 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5855 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5856
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005857 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5858 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5859 instance.
5860
5861 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5862 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5863 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5864 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5865 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5866 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005867 to 32 characters.
5868
5869 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5870 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5871 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5872 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5873 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5874 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005875
5876 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005877 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5878 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005879 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5880 increase.
5881
5882 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005883 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5884 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5885 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005886
5887 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5888 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5889 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5890 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5891 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5892 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5893 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5894 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5895 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5896 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5897 parameter (see below).
5898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005899 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5900 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5901 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5902 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5903 soft restart.
5904
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005905 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5906
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005907 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5908 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5909 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5910 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5911 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005912 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005913 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5914 if not expiration delay is specified.
5915
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005916 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5917 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5918 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5919 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005920 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5921 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5922 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5923 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5924 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5925 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5926 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5927 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5928 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5929 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5930 types and their arguments.
5931
5932 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5933 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5934 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5935 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5936
5937 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5938 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5939 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5940 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5941
5942 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5943 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5944 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5945 they were received.
5946
5947 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5948 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5949 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5950 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5951 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5952
5953 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5954 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5955 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5956 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5957 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5958
5959 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5960 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5961 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5962
5963 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5964 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5965 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5966 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5967 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5968
5969 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5970 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5971 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5972 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5973 the client side.
5974
5975 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5976 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5977 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5978 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5979 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5980 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5981 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5982
5983 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5984 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5985 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5986 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5987 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5988 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5989 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5990
5991 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5992 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5993 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5994 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5995 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5996 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5997
5998 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5999 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6000 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6001 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6002
6003 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6004 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6005 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6006 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6007 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6008 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6009 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6010 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6011 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6012 recommended for better fairness.
6013
6014 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6015 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6016 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6017 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6018
6019 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6020 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6021 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6022 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6023 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6024 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6025 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6026 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6027 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6028 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006029
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006030 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6031 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006032 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6033 reference it.
6034
6035 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6036 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6037 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6038 as an exclusive stickiness.
6039
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006040 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6041 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6042 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6043 something that can be ignored.
6044
6045 Example:
6046 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6047 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6048 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6049 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6050
6051 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006052 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006053
6054
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006055stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6056 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6058 no | no | yes | yes
6059
6060 Arguments :
6061 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
6062 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6063 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6064 server is selected.
6065
6066 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6067 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6068 the "stick-table" statement.
6069
6070 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6071 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6072 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6073 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6074
6075 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6076 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6077 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6078 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6079 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6080 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006081 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006082 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6083 rules.
6084
6085 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6086 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6087 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6088 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6089 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6090 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6091 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6092
6093 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6094 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6095 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6096 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6097
6098 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6099 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6100 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6101 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6102 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6103 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
6104 another protocol or access method.
6105
6106 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6107
6108 Example :
6109 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6110 backend https
6111 mode tcp
6112 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006113 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006114 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006115
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006116 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6117 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6118
6119 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6120 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6121 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6122
6123 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6124 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006125
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006126 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6127 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6128 # at offset 44.
6129
6130 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6131 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6132
6133 # Learn on response if server hello.
6134 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006135
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006136 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6137 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6138
6139 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6140 extraction.
6141
6142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006143tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6144 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6146 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006147 Arguments :
6148 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6149 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6150 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006151
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006152 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006153
6154 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6155 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006156 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6157 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6158 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6159 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6160 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6161 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006163 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6164 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6165 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6166 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006167
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006168 Three types of actions are supported :
6169 - accept :
6170 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6171 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6172 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006174 - reject :
6175 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6176 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6177 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6178 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6179 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6180 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6181 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6182 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6183 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6184 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6185 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6186 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006187
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006188 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6189 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6190 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6191 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6192 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6193 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6194 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6195 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6196 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006198 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006199 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
6200 in section 7.8. It describes what elements of the incoming
6201 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6202 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6203 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6204 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006206 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6207 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6208 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6209 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006211 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6212 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6213 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6214 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6215 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006216 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6217 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6218 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6219 layer7 information is extracted.
6220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006221 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6222 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6223 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6224 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6225 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006227 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6228 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6229 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006231 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6232 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6233 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006234
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006235 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006236 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006237 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006239 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6240 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6241 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006242
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006243 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6244 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6245 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006246
6247 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006249 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006250
6251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006252tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6253 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006255 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006256 Arguments :
6257 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6258 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6259 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006261 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006263 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6264 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6265 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6266 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6267 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006269 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6270 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6271 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6272 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6273 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6274 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6275 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6276 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6277 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006279 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6280 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6281 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6282 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006284 Three types of actions are supported :
6285 - accept :
6286 - reject :
6287 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006289 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6290 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006292 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6293 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6294 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006295 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6296 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6297 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6298 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
6299 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track per-frontend
6300 counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006302 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006303 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6304 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006306 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006307 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6308 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6309 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6310 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6311 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006312
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006313 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6314 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6315 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6316 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6317
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006318 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006319 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6320 # and reject everything else.
6321 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6322 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006323 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006324 tcp-request content reject
6325
6326 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006327 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6328 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6329 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006330 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006331
6332 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6333 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6334 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006335 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006336 tcp-request content reject
6337
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006338 Example:
6339 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6340 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6341 tcp-request content track-sc1 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
6342
6343 Example:
6344 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6345 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6346 tcp-request content track-sc1 base table req-rate if HTTP
6347
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006348 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6349 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6350
6351 frontend http
6352 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6353 # protecting all our sites
6354 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6355 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6356 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6357 ...
6358 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6359
6360 backend http_dynamic
6361 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6362 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6363 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6364 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6365 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6366 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6367 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006369 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006371 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006372
6373
6374tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6375 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006377 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006378 Arguments :
6379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6381 as explained at the top of this document.
6382
6383 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6384 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6385 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6386 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6387 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6388
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006389 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6390 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6391 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6392 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6393
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006394 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6395 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006396 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006397 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006398 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6399 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6400 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6401 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006402
6403 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6404 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6405 it pass through unaffected.
6406
6407 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6408 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6409 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006410 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006411 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6412 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006413 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6414 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6415 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006416
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006417 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006418 "timeout client".
6419
6420
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006421tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6422 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6424 no | no | yes | yes
6425 Arguments :
6426 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6427 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6428 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6429
6430 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6431
6432 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6433 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6434 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6435 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006436 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006437
6438 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6439
6440 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6441 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6442 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6443 inserted.
6444
6445 Two types of actions are supported :
6446 - accept :
6447 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6448 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6449 the rules evaluation.
6450
6451 - reject :
6452 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6453 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006454 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006455
6456 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6457 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6458 for changing the default action to a reject.
6459
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006460 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6461 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6462 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6463 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006464 period.
6465
6466 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6467
6468 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6469
6470
6471tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6472 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 no | no | yes | yes
6475 Arguments :
6476 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6477 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6478 as explained at the top of this document.
6479
6480 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6481
6482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006483timeout check <timeout>
6484 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6485 established.
6486
6487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | no | yes | yes
6489 Arguments:
6490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6492 as explained at the top of this document.
6493
6494 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6495 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6496 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6497 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006498 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6499 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6500 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006501
6502 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6503 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6504
6505 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6506 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006507 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006508
6509 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6510 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6511 forget about it.
6512
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006513 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6514 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006515
6516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006517timeout client <timeout>
6518timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6519 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | yes | yes | no
6522 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006523 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6525 as explained at the top of this document.
6526
6527 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6528 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6529 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6530 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6531 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6532 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6533 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6534 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006535 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006536 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006537 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6538 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6539 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006540
6541 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6542 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6543 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6544 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6545 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6546 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6547
6548 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6549 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6550 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6551
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006552 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006553
6554
6555timeout connect <timeout>
6556timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6557 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 yes | no | yes | yes
6560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006561 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006562 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6563 as explained at the top of this document.
6564
6565 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006566 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006567 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006568 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006569 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6570 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006571
6572 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6573 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6574 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6575 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6576 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6577 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6578
6579 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6580 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6581 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6582
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006583 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6584 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006585
6586
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006587timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6588 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6590 yes | yes | yes | yes
6591 Arguments :
6592 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6593 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6594 as explained at the top of this document.
6595
6596 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6597 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6598 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6599 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6600 once the request has started to present itself.
6601
6602 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6603 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6604 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6605 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6606 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6607
6608 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6609 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6610 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6611 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6612
6613 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6614 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6615 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6616 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6617 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006618 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006619
6620 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6621 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6622 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6623 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6624
6625 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6626
6627
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006628timeout http-request <timeout>
6629 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006632 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6635 as explained at the top of this document.
6636
6637 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6638 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6639 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6640 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6641 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6642 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6643 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6644 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6645
6646 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6647 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006648 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6649 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006650
6651 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6652 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6653 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6654 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6655 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6656
6657 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006658 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6659 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6660 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006661
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006662 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006663
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006664
6665timeout queue <timeout>
6666 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | no | yes | yes
6669 Arguments :
6670 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6671 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6672 as explained at the top of this document.
6673
6674 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6675 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6676 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6677 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6678 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6679
6680 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6681 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6682 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6683 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6684
6685 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6686
6687
6688timeout server <timeout>
6689timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6690 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | no | yes | yes
6693 Arguments :
6694 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6695 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6696 as explained at the top of this document.
6697
6698 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6699 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6700 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6701 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6702 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6703 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6704 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6705
6706 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6707 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6708 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6709 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6710 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006711 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006712 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006713 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6714 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6715 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6716 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006717
6718 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6719 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6720 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6721 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6722 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6723 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6724
6725 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6726 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6727 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6728
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006729 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006730
6731
6732timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006733 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6735 yes | yes | yes | yes
6736 Arguments :
6737 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6739 as explained at the top of this document.
6740
6741 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6742 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6743 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6744
6745 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6746 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6747 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6748 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006749 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006750
6751 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6752
6753
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006754timeout tunnel <timeout>
6755 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 yes | no | yes | yes
6758 Arguments :
6759 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6760 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6761 as explained at the top of this document.
6762
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006763 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006764 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6765 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6766 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6767 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6768 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6769 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6770 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6771 specified.
6772
6773 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6774 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6775 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6776 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6777 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6778
6779 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6780 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6781 forget about it.
6782
6783 Example :
6784 defaults http
6785 option http-server-close
6786 timeout connect 5s
6787 timeout client 30s
6788 timeout client 30s
6789 timeout server 30s
6790 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6791
6792 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6793
6794
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006795transparent (deprecated)
6796 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006798 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006799 Arguments : none
6800
6801 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6802 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6803 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6804 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6805 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6806 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6807 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6808 appropriate server.
6809
6810 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6811
6812 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6813 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6814
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006815 See also: "option transparent"
6816
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006817unique-id-format <string>
6818 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6820 yes | yes | yes | no
6821 Arguments :
6822 <string> is a log-format string.
6823
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006824 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6825 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6826 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6827 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006829 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6830 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6831 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6832 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6833 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6834 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6835 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6836 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006837
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006838 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6839 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006840
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006841 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006842
6843 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6844
6845 will generate:
6846
6847 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6848
6849 See also: "unique-id-header"
6850
6851unique-id-header <name>
6852 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6854 yes | yes | yes | no
6855 Arguments :
6856 <name> is the name of the header.
6857
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006858 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6859 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006860
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006861 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006862
6863 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6864 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6865
6866 will generate:
6867
6868 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6869
6870 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006871
6872use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6873use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006874 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6876 no | yes | yes | no
6877 Arguments :
6878 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006880 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006881
6882 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6883 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6884 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006885 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6886 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6887 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6888 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006889
6890 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6891 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6892 assign the backend.
6893
6894 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6895 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6896 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6897 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6898 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6899 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6900
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006901 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006902 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006903 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6904 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6905 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6906
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006907 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006908
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006909
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006910use-server <server> if <condition>
6911use-server <server> unless <condition>
6912 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 no | no | yes | yes
6915 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006916 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006917
6918 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6919
6920 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6921 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6922 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6923
6924 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6925 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6926 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6927 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6928 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6929 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6930 matches will assign the server.
6931
6932 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6933 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6934 with the next rules until one matches.
6935
6936 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6937 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6938 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6939 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6940
6941 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6942 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6943 stripped.
6944
6945 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6946 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6947 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6948 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6949
6950 Example :
6951 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6952 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6953 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6954 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6955 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6956 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6957 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6958 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6959 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6960
6961 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6962
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006963
69645. Bind and Server options
6965--------------------------
6966
6967The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6968depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6969settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6970written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6971described in this section.
6972
6973
69745.1. Bind options
6975-----------------
6976
6977The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6978as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6979no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6980parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6981while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6982provided immediately after the setting name.
6983
6984The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6985
6986accept-proxy
6987 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6988 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6989 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6990 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6991 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6992 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6993 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6994 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6995 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6996 usable.
6997
6998backlog <backlog>
6999 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7000 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7001
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007002ecdhe <named curve>
7003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7004 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
7005 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
7006
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007007ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7009 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7010 client's certificate.
7011
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007012ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7014 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7015 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7016 error is ignored.
7017
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007018ciphers <ciphers>
7019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7020 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7021 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7022 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7023 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7024
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007025crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7027 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7028 to verify client's certificate.
7029
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007030crt <cert>
7031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7032 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7033 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007034 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
7035 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
7036 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
7037 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
7038 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
7039 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
7040 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
7041 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007042 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007043 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
7044 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
7045 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
7046 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7047 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007048
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007049crt-ignore-err <errors>
7050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7051 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
7052 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
7053 error is ignored.
7054
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007055defer-accept
7056 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7057 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7058 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7059 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7060 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7061 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7062 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7063 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7064 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7065 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7066 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7067
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007068force-sslv3
7069 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7070 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7071 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7072
7073force-tlsv10
7074 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7075 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7076
7077force-tlsv11
7078 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7079 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7080
7081force-tlsv12
7082 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7083 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007085gid <gid>
7086 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7087 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7088 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7089 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7090 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7091
7092group <group>
7093 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7094 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7095 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7096 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7097 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7098
7099id <id>
7100 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7101 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7102 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7103 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7104
7105interface <interface>
7106 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
7107 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
7108 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
7109 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
7110 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
7111 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
7112 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
7113 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
7114
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007115level <level>
7116 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7117 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7118 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7119 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7120 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7121 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7122 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7123 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7124 counters).
7125 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7126 all counters).
7127
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007128maxconn <maxconn>
7129 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7130 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7131 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7132 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7133 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7134 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7135 eat all memory.
7136
7137mode <mode>
7138 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7139 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7140 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7141 UNIX sockets.
7142
7143mss <maxseg>
7144 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7145 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7146 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7147 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7148 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7149 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7150 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7151 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7152 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7153 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7154 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7155
7156name <name>
7157 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7158 page.
7159
7160nice <nice>
7161 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7162 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7163 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7164 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7165 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7166 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7167 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7168 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7169 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7170 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7171 one for an RDP socket.
7172
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007173no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007174 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7175 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7176 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007177 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7178 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007179
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007180no-tls-tickets
7181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7182 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7183 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7184 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7185
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007186no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007188 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7189 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7190 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7191 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007192
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007193no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007195 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7196 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7197 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7198 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007199
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007200no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007202 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7203 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7204 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7205 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007206
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007207npn <protocols>
7208 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7209 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7210 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7211 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7212 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7213
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007214ssl
7215 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7216 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7217 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7218 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7219 to deciphered contents.
7220
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007221tfo
7222 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7223 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7224 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7225 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7226 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7227 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7228 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7229 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7230 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7231
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007232transparent
7233 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7234 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7235 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7236 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7237 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7238 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7239 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7240 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7241 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7242 so check for support with your vendor.
7243
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007244v4v6
7245 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7246 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7247 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7248 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7249 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7250
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007251v6only
7252 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7253 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7254 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007255 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7256 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007258uid <uid>
7259 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7260 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7261 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7262 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7263 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7264
7265user <user>
7266 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7267 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7268 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7269 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7270 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7271
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007272verify [none|optional|required]
7273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7274 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7275 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7276 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7277 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007278 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7279 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7280 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7281 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020072835.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007284------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007286The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7287which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7288arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7289settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7290after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7291Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7292address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007294 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007295 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007297The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007298
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007299addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007300 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7301 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7302 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7303 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7304 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007306 Supported in default-server: No
7307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007308backup
7309 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7310 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7311 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7312 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7313 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7314 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007316 Supported in default-server: No
7317
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007318ca-file <cafile>
7319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7320 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7321 server's certificate.
7322
7323 Supported in default-server: No
7324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007325check
7326 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007327 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7328 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7329 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7330 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7331 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7332 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7333 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7334 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7335 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7336 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007338 Supported in default-server: No
7339
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007340check-send-proxy
7341 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7342 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7343 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7344 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7345 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7346 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7347 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7348
7349 Supported in default-server: No
7350
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007351check-ssl
7352 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7353 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7354 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7355 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7356 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7357 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7358 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7359 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7360 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7361
7362 Supported in default-server: No
7363
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007364ciphers <ciphers>
7365 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7366 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7367 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7368 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7369 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7370 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7371 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7372 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7373
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007374 Supported in default-server: No
7375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007376cookie <value>
7377 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7378 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7379 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7380 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7381 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7382 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7383 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007385 Supported in default-server: No
7386
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007387crl-file <crlfile>
7388 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7389 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7390 to verify server's certificate.
7391
7392 Supported in default-server: No
7393
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007394crt <cert>
7395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7396 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7397 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7398 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7399 certificate request.
7400
7401 Supported in default-server: No
7402
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007403disabled
7404 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7405 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7406 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7407 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7408 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7409
7410 Supported in default-server: No
7411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007412error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007413 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7414 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7415 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007417 Supported in default-server: Yes
7418
7419 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007421fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007422 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7423 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7424 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007426 Supported in default-server: Yes
7427
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007428force-sslv3
7429 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7430 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7431 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7432
7433 Supported in default-server: No
7434
7435force-tlsv10
7436 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7437 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7438
7439 Supported in default-server: No
7440
7441force-tlsv11
7442 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7443 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7444
7445 Supported in default-server: No
7446
7447force-tlsv12
7448 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7449 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7450
7451 Supported in default-server: No
7452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007453id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007454 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7455 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7456 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007458 Supported in default-server: No
7459
7460inter <delay>
7461fastinter <delay>
7462downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007463 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7464 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7465 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7466 between checks depending on the server state :
7467
7468 Server state | Interval used
7469 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7470 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7471 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7472 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7473 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7474 or yet unchecked. |
7475 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7476 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7477 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007479 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7480 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7481 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7482 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7483 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7484 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7485 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7486 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7487 servers.
7488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007489 Supported in default-server: Yes
7490
7491maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007492 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7493 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7494 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7495 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7496 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7497 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7498 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7499 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007501 Supported in default-server: Yes
7502
7503maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007504 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7505 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7506 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7507 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7508 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7509 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7510 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7511
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007512 Supported in default-server: Yes
7513
7514minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007515 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7516 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7517 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7518 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7519 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7520 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007521 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007522 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007524 Supported in default-server: Yes
7525
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007526no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007527 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7528 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007529 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007530
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007531 Supported in default-server: No
7532
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007533no-tls-tickets
7534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7535 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7536 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7537 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7538
7539 Supported in default-server: No
7540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007541no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007542 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007543 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7544 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007545 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7546 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007547
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007548 Supported in default-server: No
7549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007550no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007551 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007552 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7553 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007554 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7555 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007556
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007557 Supported in default-server: No
7558
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007559no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007560 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007561 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7562 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007563 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7564 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007565
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007566 Supported in default-server: No
7567
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007568non-stick
7569 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7570 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7571 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7572
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007573 Supported in default-server: No
7574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007575observe <mode>
7576 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7577 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7578 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7579 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7580 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7581 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007582 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007584 Supported in default-server: No
7585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007586 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007588on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007589 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7590 Currently, four modes are available:
7591 - fastinter: force fastinter
7592 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7593 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7594 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7595 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007597 Supported in default-server: Yes
7598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007599 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7600
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007601on-marked-down <action>
7602 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7603 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007604 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7605 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7606 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7607 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7608 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7609 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7610 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7611 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007612
7613 Actions are disabled by default
7614
7615 Supported in default-server: Yes
7616
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007617on-marked-up <action>
7618 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7619 Currently one action is available:
7620 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7621 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7622 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7623 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7624 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7625 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7626 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7627 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7628
7629 Actions are disabled by default
7630
7631 Supported in default-server: Yes
7632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007633port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007634 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7635 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7636 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7637 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7638 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7639 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007641 Supported in default-server: Yes
7642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007643redir <prefix>
7644 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7645 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7646 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7647 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7648 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7649 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7650 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7651 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007652 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007653 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7654 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7655 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7656 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7657 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7658
7659 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007661 Supported in default-server: No
7662
7663rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007664 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7665 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7666 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007668 Supported in default-server: Yes
7669
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007670send-proxy
7671 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7672 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7673 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7674 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7675 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7676 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7677 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7678 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7679 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007680 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7681 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7682 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7683 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7684 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007685
7686 Supported in default-server: No
7687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007688slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007689 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7690 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7691 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7692 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7693 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7694 parameters :
7695
7696 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7697 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7698
7699 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7700 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7701 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7702 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7703
7704 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7705 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7706 seen as failed.
7707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007708 Supported in default-server: Yes
7709
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007710source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007711source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007712source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007713 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7714 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7715 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7716 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7717
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007718 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7719 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7720 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7721 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7722 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7723 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7724 server.
7725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007726 Supported in default-server: No
7727
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007728ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007729 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7730 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7731 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7732 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7733 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7734 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7735 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7736 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7737
7738 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007740track [<proxy>/]<server>
7741 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7742 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7743 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7744 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7745 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007747 Supported in default-server: No
7748
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007749verify [none|required]
7750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7751 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7752 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7753 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7754 is aborted.
7755
7756 Supported in default-server: No
7757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007758weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007759 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7760 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7761 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007762 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7763 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7764 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7765 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7766 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7767 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007769 Supported in default-server: Yes
7770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007771
77726. HTTP header manipulation
7773---------------------------
7774
7775In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7776response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7777request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7778which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7779against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7780to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7781passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7782headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7783never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7784
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007785There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7786(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7787rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7788messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7789in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007790happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007791add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7792normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007794This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7795in section 4.2 :
7796
7797 - reqadd <string>
7798 - reqallow <search>
7799 - reqiallow <search>
7800 - reqdel <search>
7801 - reqidel <search>
7802 - reqdeny <search>
7803 - reqideny <search>
7804 - reqpass <search>
7805 - reqipass <search>
7806 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7807 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7808 - reqtarpit <search>
7809 - reqitarpit <search>
7810 - rspadd <string>
7811 - rspdel <search>
7812 - rspidel <search>
7813 - rspdeny <search>
7814 - rspideny <search>
7815 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7816 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7817
7818With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7819is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7820parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7821prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7822Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7823
7824 \t for a tab
7825 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7826 \n for a new line (LF)
7827 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7828 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7829 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7830 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7831 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7832
7833The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7834portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7835above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7836regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
78379 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7838is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7839
7840The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7841after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7842
7843Notes related to these keywords :
7844---------------------------------
7845 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7846 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7847 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7848
7849 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7850 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7851 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7852
7853 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7854 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7855 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7856 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7857 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7858
7859 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7860 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7861 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7862 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7863 useless headers before adding new ones.
7864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007865 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007866 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7867
7868 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7869 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7870 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7871
7872 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7873 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007874 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007875
7876
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078777. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7878------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007879
7880The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7881content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7882from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7883simple :
7884
7885 - define test criteria with sets of values
7886 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7887
7888The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7889
7890In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7891
7892 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7893
7894This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7895Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7896and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7897an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7898of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7899
7900ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7901'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7902which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7903
7904There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7905performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7906
7907The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7908
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007909 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7910 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007911 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7912
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007913The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7914specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7915possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007916multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7917be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7918needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7919space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7920match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7921lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7922duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007923to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007924instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007925
7926 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7927
7928In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7929the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7930case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7931too.
7932
7933Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7934a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7935ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007937Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007939 - integers or integer ranges
7940 - strings
7941 - regular expressions
7942 - IP addresses and networks
7943
7944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079457.1. Matching integers
7946----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007947
7948Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7949that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7950expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7951may be omitted.
7952
7953For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7954unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7955representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7956
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007957As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7958two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7959instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7960ranges and operators.
7961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007962For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007963operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7964Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7965of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007966
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007967Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007968
7969 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7970 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7971 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7972 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7973 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7974
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007975For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007976
7977 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7978
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007979This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7980
7981 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7982
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079847.2. Matching strings
7985---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007986
7987String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7988exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7989characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7990string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7991to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007992before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007993
7994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079957.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7996-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007997
7998Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7999they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8000possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8001passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8002the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008003the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8004match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008005
8006
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020080077.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008008----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008009
8010IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8011netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8012within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008013host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008014difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8015at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8016does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8017parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008018
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008019IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8020Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8021trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8022IPv6 patterns.
8023
8024HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8025following situations :
8026 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8027 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8028 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8029 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8030 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8031 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8032 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8033 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8034 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8035 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080387.5. Available matching criteria
8039--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080417.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
8042------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008043
8044A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
8045analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008046addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008048always_false
8049 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8050 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8051
8052always_true
8053 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
8054 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
8055
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008056avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008057avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008058 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
8059 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
8060 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
8061 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
8062 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
8063 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
8064 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
8065 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
8066 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
8067 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
8068 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01008069
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008070be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008071be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008072 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
8073 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
8074 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8075 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
8076 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008077
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008078be_id <integer>
8079 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
8080 backend it was called.
8081
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008082be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008083be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008084 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
8085 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8086 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8087 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8088 sucking of an online dictionary).
8089
8090 Example :
8091 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
8092 backend dynamic
8093 mode http
8094 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
8095 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008096
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05008097srv_sess_rate(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
8098 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the server matches the
8099 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
8100 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
8101 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
8102 latent requests from overloading servers).
8103
8104 Example :
8105 # Redirect to a separate back
8106 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
8107 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
8108 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
8109
8110
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008111connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008112connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008113 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008114 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008115 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
8116
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008117 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
8118 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008119
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008120 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008121 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
8122 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
8123 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
8124 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
8125 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008126 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008127
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008128 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
8129 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
8130 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
8131 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08008132
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008133dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008134 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
8135 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008136
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008137dst_conn <integer>
8138 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
8139 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
8140 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
8141 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
8142 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
8143 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
8144
8145dst_port <integer>
8146 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
8147 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
8148
8149fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008150fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008151 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
8152 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
8153 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
8154 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
8155 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
8156 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
8157 criteria.
8158
8159fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008160 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008161 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02008162
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008163fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008164fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008165 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
8166 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
8167 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
8168 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8169 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8170 the rate to go down below the limit.
8171
8172 Example :
8173 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8174 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8175 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8176 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8177 frontend mail
8178 bind :25
8179 mode tcp
8180 maxconn 100
8181 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8182 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8183 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8184 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008186nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008187nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008188 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8189 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8190 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8191 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8192 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008194queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008195queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008196 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8197 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8198 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8199 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8200 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8201 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8202 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008204sc1_bytes_in_rate
8205sc2_bytes_in_rate
8206 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8207 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8208 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8209
8210sc1_bytes_out_rate
8211sc2_bytes_out_rate
8212 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8213 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8214 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8215
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008216sc1_clr_gpc0
8217sc2_clr_gpc0
8218 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8219 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8220 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8221 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8222 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8223 was verified :
8224
8225 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8226 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8227 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8228 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8229 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8230 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8231 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008233sc1_conn_cnt
8234sc2_conn_cnt
8235 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8236 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8237
8238sc1_conn_cur
8239sc2_conn_cur
8240 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8241 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8242 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8243
8244sc1_conn_rate
8245sc2_conn_rate
8246 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8247 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8248 See also src_conn_rate.
8249
8250sc1_get_gpc0
8251sc2_get_gpc0
8252 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8253 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8254
8255sc1_http_err_cnt
8256sc2_http_err_cnt
8257 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8258 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8259 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8260
8261sc1_http_err_rate
8262sc2_http_err_rate
8263 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8264 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8265 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8266 src_http_err_rate.
8267
8268sc1_http_req_cnt
8269sc2_http_req_cnt
8270 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8271 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8272 src_http_req_cnt.
8273
8274sc1_http_req_rate
8275sc2_http_req_rate
8276 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8277 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8278 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8279 src_http_req_rate.
8280
8281sc1_inc_gpc0
8282sc2_inc_gpc0
8283 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8284 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8285 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8286 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8287 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8288 when a first ACL was verified :
8289
8290 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8291 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8292 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8293
8294sc1_kbytes_in
8295sc2_kbytes_in
8296 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8297 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8298 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8299 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8300
8301sc1_kbytes_out
8302sc2_kbytes_out
8303 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8304 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8305 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8306 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8307
8308sc1_sess_cnt
8309sc2_sess_cnt
8310 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8311 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8312 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8313 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008314 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008315 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8316
8317sc1_sess_rate
8318sc2_sess_rate
8319 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8320 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8321 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8322 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8323 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008324 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008325
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01008326sc1_trackers
8327sc2_trackers
8328 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8329 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8330 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc1_conn_cur in
8331 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
8332 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
8333 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking.
8334
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008335so_id <integer>
8336 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8337
8338src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008339 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8340 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8341 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008342
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008343src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008344src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008345 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8346 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8347 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008348 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008349
8350src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008351src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008352 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8353 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8354 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008355 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008356
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008357src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8358src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8359 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8360 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8361 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8362 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8363 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8364 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8365
8366 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8367 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8368 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8369 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8370 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8371 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8372 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8373
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008374src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008375src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008376 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8377 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8378 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008379 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008380
8381src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008382src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008383 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8384 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8385 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008386 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008387
8388src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008389src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008390 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8391 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8392 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008393 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008394
8395src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008396src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008397 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8398 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8399 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008400 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008401
8402src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008403src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008404 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8405 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8406 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008407 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008408
8409src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008410src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008411 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8412 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8413 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8414 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008415 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008416
8417src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008418src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008419 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8420 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8421 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008422 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008423
8424src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008425src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008426 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8427 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8428 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8429 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008430 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008431
8432src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008433src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008434 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8435 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8436 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8437 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8438 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8439 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8440
8441 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8442 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008443 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008444
8445src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008446src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008447 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8448 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8449 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8450 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008451 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008452
8453src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008454src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008455 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8456 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8457 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8458 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008459 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008460
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008461src_port <integer>
8462 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008463
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008464src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008465src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008466 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8467 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8468 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8469 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008470 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008471
8472src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008473src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008474 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8475 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8476 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8477 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008478 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008479
8480src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008481src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008482 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008483 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8484 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008485 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8486 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8487 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008488 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008489
8490 Example :
8491 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8492 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8493 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8494 listen ssh
8495 bind :22
8496 mode tcp
8497 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008498 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008499 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8500 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8501
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008502srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008503 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8504 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8505 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8506 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8507
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008508srv_id <integer>
8509 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8510
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008511srv_is_up(<server>)
8512srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8513 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8514 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8515 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8516 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8517 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8518 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8519 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8520 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8521
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008522table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008523table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008524 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8525 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8526
8527table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008528table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008529 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8530 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8531 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020085347.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8535---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008536
8537A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8538during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008539through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8540keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008541
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008542rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8543 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8544 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8545 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008546 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8547 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8548 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008549
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008550req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008551 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008552 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8553 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8554 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8555 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8556 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8557 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8558
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008559req_proto_http
8560 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8561 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008562 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008563 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8564 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8565
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008566req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008567req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008568 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8569 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8570 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8571 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8572 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8573 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8574 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8575 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8576
8577req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008578req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008579 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8580 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8581 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8582 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8583 cookies.
8584
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008585req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8586 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8587 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8588 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008589 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8590 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8591 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008592
8593req_ssl_sni <string>
8594 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8595 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8596 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8597 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8598 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8599 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8600 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008601 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8602 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008603 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008604 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008605
8606 Examples :
8607 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8608 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8609 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8610 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8611 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8612
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008613req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8614 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8615 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8616 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8617 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8618 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8619 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008620 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8621 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008622 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008623 option.
8624
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008625ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8626 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8627 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8628 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8629 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8630 during this verification process.
8631
8632ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8633 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8634 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8635 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8636 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8637
8638ssl_c_err <integer>
8639 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8640 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8641 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8642 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8643
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008644ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8645ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8646 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8647 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8648 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8649 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8650 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8651 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8652 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8653 DN matches the specified string.
8654
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008655ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8656 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8657 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8658 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8659
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008660ssl_c_notafter <string>
8661 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8662 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8663 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8664
8665ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8666 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8667 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8668 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8669
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008670ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8671ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8672 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8673 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8674 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8675 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8676 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8677 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8678 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8679 DN matches the specified string.
8680
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008681ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8682 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8683 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8684 the value written in hexa.
8685
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008686ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8687 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8688 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8689 by the client matches the string.
8690
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008691ssl_c_used
8692 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
8693 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
8694
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008695ssl_c_verify <integer>
8696 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8697 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8698 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8699
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008700ssl_c_version <integer>
8701 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8702 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8703 the value.
8704
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008705ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8706ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8707 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8708 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8709 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8710 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8711 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8712 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8713 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8714 DN matches the specified string.
8715
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008716ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8717 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8718 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8719 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8720
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008721ssl_f_notafter <string>
8722 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8723 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8724 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8725
8726ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8727 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8728 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8729 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8730
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008731ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8732ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8733 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8734 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8735 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8736 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8737 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8738 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8739 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8740 DN matches the specified string.
8741
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008742ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8743 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8744 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8745 the value written in hexa.
8746
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008747ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8748 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8749 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8750 by the frontend matches the string.
8751
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008752ssl_f_version <integer>
8753 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8754 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8755 the value.
8756
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008757ssl_fc
8758 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8759 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8760 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8761
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008762ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8763 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8764 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8765
8766ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8767 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8768 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8769
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008770ssl_fc_has_crt
8771 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8772 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01008773 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
8774 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
8775 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
8776 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008777
8778ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008779 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008780 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8781 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8782 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8783 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008784
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008785ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008786 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8787 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8788 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8789 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008790 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8791 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8792 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008793
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008794ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8795 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8796 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8797
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008798ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008799 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8800 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8801 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8802 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008803 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8804 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008805 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8806 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8807 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008808
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008809ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008810 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8811 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8812 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8813 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008814 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8815 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8816 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8817 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008818
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008819ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008820 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8821 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8822 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8823 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008824 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8825 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8826 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8827 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008828
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008829ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8830 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8831 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8832
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008833wait_end
8834 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8835 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8836 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8837 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8838 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8839 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8840 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8841 inspection.
8842
8843 Examples :
8844 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8845 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8846 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8847
8848 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8849 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8850 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8851 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8852 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8853 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8854 tcp-request content reject
8855
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088577.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8858--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008859
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008860A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008861application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8862read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8863than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8864
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008865base <string>
8866 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8867 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8868 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8869 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8870 See also "path" and "uri".
8871
8872base_beg <string>
8873 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8874 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8875 "path_beg".
8876
8877base_dir <string>
8878 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8879 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8880 "path_dir" instead.
8881
8882base_dom <string>
8883 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8884 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8885 instead.
8886
8887base_end <string>
8888 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8889 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8890
8891base_len <integer>
8892 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8893 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8894
8895base_reg <regex>
8896 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8897 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8898 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8899 and all "base_" criteria.
8900
8901base_sub <string>
8902 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8903 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8904 also "base_dir".
8905
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008906cook(<name>) <string>
8907 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8908 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8909 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8910 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8911 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8912 sent by the server.
8913
8914 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8915 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8916 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8917
8918 cook(profile) silver gold
8919
8920cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8921 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8922 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8923 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8924
8925cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8926 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8927 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8928 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8929 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8930 server.
8931
8932cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8933 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8934 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8935 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8936 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8937 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8938
8939cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8940 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8941 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8942 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8943 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8944
8945cook_end(<name>) <string>
8946 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8947 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8948 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8949
8950cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8951 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8952 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8953 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8954 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8955 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8956
8957cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8958 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8959 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8960 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8961 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8962 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8963
8964cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8965 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8966 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8967 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8968
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008969cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8970 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8971 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8972 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8973 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8974 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8975
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008976hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008977hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008978 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8979 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8980 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8981 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008982 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8983 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8984 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8985 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8986 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008987
8988 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008989 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008990 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8991
8992 hdr(Connection) -i close
8993
8994hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008995hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008996 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8997 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8998 response headers sent by the server.
8999
9000hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009001hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009002 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
9003 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
9004 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
9005 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
9006 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
9007 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
9008 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9009
9010hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009011hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009012 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9013 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
9014 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
9015 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
9016 headers sent by the server.
9017
9018hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009019hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009020 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
9021 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
9022 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
9023 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
9024 server.
9025
9026hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009027hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009028 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
9029 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
9030 response headers sent by the server.
9031
9032hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009033hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
9034 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9035 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
9036 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009037 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9038
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009039hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009040hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009041 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
9042 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
9043 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
9044 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9045
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009046hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009047hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02009048 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009049 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
9050 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
9051 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
9052 response headers sent by the server.
9053
9054hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009055hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009056 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
9057 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
9058 response headers sent by the server.
9059
9060hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009061hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009062 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
9063 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
9064 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
9065 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
9066
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009067http_auth(<userlist>)
9068http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009069 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
9070 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
9071 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
9072 of specified groups.
9073
9074 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
9075
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02009076http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02009077 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
9078 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
9079 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
9080 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
9081
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009082method <string>
9083 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
9084 already check for most common methods.
9085
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009086path <string>
9087 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
9088 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
9089 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
9090
9091path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009092 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
9093 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009094
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009095path_dir <string>
9096 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9097 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9098 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9099 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
9100
9101path_dom <string>
9102 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9103 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
9104 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
9105
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009106path_end <string>
9107 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
9108 control file name extension.
9109
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009110path_len <integer>
9111 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
9112 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9113
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009114path_reg <regex>
9115 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9116 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
9117 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
9118
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009119path_sub <string>
9120 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9121 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
9122 "path_dir".
9123
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02009124payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
9125 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
9126 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
9127 strings.
9128
9129payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
9130 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
9131 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
9132 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
9133 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
9134 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
9135
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009136req_ver <string>
9137 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
9138 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
9139
9140status <integer>
9141 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
9142 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
9143 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
9144
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009145url <string>
9146 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009147 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009148
9149url_beg <string>
9150 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009151 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
9152 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009154url_dir <string>
9155 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
9156 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
9157 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
9158 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
9159
9160url_dom <string>
9161 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9162 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
9163 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
9164
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009165url_end <string>
9166 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
9167 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009168
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009169url_ip <address>
9170 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
9171 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
9172 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009173
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02009174url_len <integer>
9175 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
9176 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9177
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009178url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009179 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
9180 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009181 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009182 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01009183
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009184url_reg <regex>
9185 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9186 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009187 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009188
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009189url_sub <string>
9190 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9191 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009192
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009193urlp(<name>) <string>
9194 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9195 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9196
9197 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9198 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9199
9200urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9201 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9202 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9203 protocol scheme.
9204
9205urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9206 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9207 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9208 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9209 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9210
9211urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9212 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9213 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9214 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9215 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9216
9217urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9218 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9219
9220urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009221 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9222 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009223
9224urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9225 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9226 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9227
9228urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9229 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9230 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9231 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9232 "urlp_" criteria.
9233
9234urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9235 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9236 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9237 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9238
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009239urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9240 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9241 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9242 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9243 negative data.
9244
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092467.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9247---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009249Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9250every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009251order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009253ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9254---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009255FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009256HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009257HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9258HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009259HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9260HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9261HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9262HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9263LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009264METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9265METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9266METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9267METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9268METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9269METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009270RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009271REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009272TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009273WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9274---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009275
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092777.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9278----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009280Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9281combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009283 - AND (implicit)
9284 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9285 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009287A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9292indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9295"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9296requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9297is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009299 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9300 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9301 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9302 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009304To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9305and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009307 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9308 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9309 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9310 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009312 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9313 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9314 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9315 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009316
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009317It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9318expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9319be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009320the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009321
9322 The following rule :
9323
9324 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9325 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9326
9327 Can also be written that way :
9328
9329 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9330
9331It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9332to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9333simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9334sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9335good use is the following :
9336
9337 With named ACLs :
9338
9339 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9340 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9341 monitor fail if site_dead
9342
9343 With anonymous ACLs :
9344
9345 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009347See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009348
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009349
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010093507.8. Pattern extraction
9351-----------------------
9352
9353The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9354response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9355for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9356
9357All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9358"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9359begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9360arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9361much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9362equivalent used in ACLs.
9363
9364The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9365
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009366 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9367 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9368 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9369 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9370 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9371 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9372 requested objects by host/path.
9373
Willy Tarreauab1f7b72012-12-09 13:38:54 +01009374 base32 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base"
9375 fetch method above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on
9376 high traffic sites without having to store all URLs. Instead a
9377 shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
9378 is an unsigned integer.
9379
Willy Tarreau4a550602012-12-09 14:53:32 +01009380 base32+src This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the
9381 src fetch below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a
9382 size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on the source address family.
9383 This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
9384
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009385 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009386 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9387 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9388 according to RFC 4291.
9389
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009390 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9391 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9392 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009393 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9394 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9395 according to RFC 4291.
9396
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009397 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9398 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9399 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9400 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9401 type integer and only works with such tables.
9402
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009403 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9404 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9405 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9406 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9407 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9408 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9409 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009410 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009411
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009412 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9413 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9414 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9415 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9416 wiser to use "url" instead.
9417
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009418 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009419 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9420 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9421 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9422 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009423
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009424 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009425 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9426 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9427 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9428 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9429 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9430 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9431 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9432 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009433
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009434 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9435 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9436 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9437 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9438
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009439 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9440 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9441
9442 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9443 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9444 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9445
9446 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9447 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9448
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009449 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9450 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9451 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9452 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9453 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9454 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9455 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9456 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9457 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9458 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9459 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9460
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009461 ssl_c_key_alg
9462 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9463 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9464 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9465
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009466 ssl_c_notafter
9467 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9468 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9469 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9470
9471 ssl_c_notbefore
9472 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9473 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9474 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9475
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009476 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9477 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9478 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9479 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9480 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9481 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9482 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9483 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9484 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9485 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9486 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9487
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009488 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9489 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9490 layer.
9491
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009492 ssl_c_sig_alg
9493 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9494 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9495 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9496
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009497 ssl_c_used
9498 Returns 1 if current SSL session use a client certificate,
9499 otherwise 0. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
9500
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009501 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9502 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9503 error is encountered.
9504
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009505 ssl_c_version
9506 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9507 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9508 layer.
9509
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009510 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9511 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9512 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9513 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9514 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9515 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9516 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9517 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9518 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9519 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9520 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9521
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009522 ssl_f_key_alg
9523 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9524 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9525 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9526
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009527 ssl_f_notafter
9528 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9529 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9530 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9531
9532 ssl_f_notbefore
9533 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9534 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9535 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9536
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009537 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9538 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9539 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9540 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9541 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9542 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9543 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9544 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9545 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9546 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9547 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9548
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009549 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9550 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9551 layer.
9552
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009553 ssl_f_sig_alg
9554 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9555 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9556 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9557
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009558 ssl_f_version
9559 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9560 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9561 layer.
9562
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009563 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9564 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9565 otherwise zero.
9566
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009567 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9568 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9569 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9570
9571 ssl_fc_cipher
9572 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9573 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9574
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009575 ssl_fc_has_crt
9576 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9577 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009578 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket,
9579 client certificate is not present in the current connection but
9580 may be retrieved from the cache or the ticket. So prefer
9581 "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if current SSL session uses
9582 a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009583
9584 ssl_fc_has_sni
9585 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009586 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9587 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009588 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009589 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009590
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009591 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009592 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9593 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9594 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9595 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009596 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009597
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009598 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009599 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9600 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009601
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009602 ssl_fc_session_id
9603 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9604 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9605 stick on a given client.
9606
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009607 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009608 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9609 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9610 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9611 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9612 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009613
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009614 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9615 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9616 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9617
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009618 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9619 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9620 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9621 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9622
9623 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9624 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9625 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9626 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9627 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9628 table for a given source address.
9629
9630 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9631 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9632
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009633 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009634 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009635 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9636 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9637 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9638 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9639 where cookies cannot be used.
9640
9641 Example :
9642 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9643 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9644 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9645 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009646
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009647 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009648 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9649 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9650 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9651 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009652
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009653 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9654 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9655 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9656 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9657 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9658 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9659 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009660
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009661 Example :
9662 listen tse-farm
9663 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9664 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9665 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9666 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9667 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9668 persist rdp-cookie
9669 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9670 # This is only useful makes sense if
9671 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9672 stick-table type string size 204800
9673 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9674 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9675 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009676
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009677 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9678 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009679
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009680 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009681 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009682 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9683 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9684 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9685 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9686 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9687 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009688
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009689 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009690
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009691 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009692 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9693 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9694 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009696 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9697 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9698 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9699 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9700 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009702 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009703
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009704
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009705The currently available list of transformations include :
9706
9707 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9708 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9709 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9710
9711 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9712 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9713 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9714
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009715 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009716 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9717 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9718 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9719 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097228. Logging
9723----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009724
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009725One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9726provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9727very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9728provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9729state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009730to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009731headers.
9732
9733In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9734about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9735send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9736
9737 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9738 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9739 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9740 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9741 at the termination.
9742
9743The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9744allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9745as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9746while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9747real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9748delay.
9749
9750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097518.1. Log levels
9752---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009753
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009754TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009755source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009756HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9757in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9758track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9759syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9760about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009761
9762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097638.2. Log formats
9764----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009765
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009766HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009767and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9768slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9769options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009770
9771 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9772 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9773 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9774 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9775 extents.
9776
9777 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9778 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9779 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9780 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9781 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9782
9783 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9784 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9785 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9786 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9787 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9788
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009789 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9790 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9791 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9792 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9793
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009794 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9795
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009796Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9797specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9798field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9799servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9800always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9801identifier.
9802
9803Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9804 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9805 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9806 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9807 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9808
9809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098108.2.1. Default log format
9811-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009812
9813This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9814as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9815format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9816
9817 Example :
9818 listen www
9819 mode http
9820 log global
9821 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9822
9823 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9824 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9825 (www/HTTP)
9826
9827 Field Format Extract from the example above
9828 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9829 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9830 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9831 4 'to' to
9832 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9833 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9834
9835Detailed fields description :
9836 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9837 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9838 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9839 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9840 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9841 and processed the connection.
9842 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9843
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009844In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9845"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9846connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9847
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009848It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9849will eventually disappear.
9850
9851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098528.2.2. TCP log format
9853---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009854
9855The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9856is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9857information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9858counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9859emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9860environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9861the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9862sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009863specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9864not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9865fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9866marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009867
9868 Example :
9869 frontend fnt
9870 mode tcp
9871 option tcplog
9872 log global
9873 default_backend bck
9874
9875 backend bck
9876 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9877
9878 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9879 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9880 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9881
9882 Field Format Extract from the example above
9883 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9884 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9885 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9886 4 frontend_name fnt
9887 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9888 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9889 7 bytes_read* 212
9890 8 termination_state --
9891 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9892 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9893
9894Detailed fields description :
9895 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009896 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9897 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9898 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9899 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9900 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009901
9902 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009903 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9904 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9905 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009906
9907 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9908 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9909 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9910 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9911
9912 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9913 and processed the connection.
9914
9915 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9916 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9917 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9918 applications.
9919
9920 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9921 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9922 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9923 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9924 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9925
9926 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9927 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9928 See "Timers" below for more details.
9929
9930 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9931 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9932 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9933 "Timers" below for more details.
9934
9935 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9936 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9937 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9938 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9939 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9940 details.
9941
9942 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9943 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9944 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9945 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9946 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9947
9948 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9949 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9950 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9951 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9952 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9953 for more details.
9954
9955 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009956 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009957 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9958 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9959 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009960 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009961
9962 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9963 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9964 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9965 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9966 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9967 caused by a denial of service attack.
9968
9969 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9970 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9971 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9972 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9973 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9974 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9975 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9976 denial of service attack.
9977
9978 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9979 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9980 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9981 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9982 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9983 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9984 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9985 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9986 be processed than on other servers.
9987
9988 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9989 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9990 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9991 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9992 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9993 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9994 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9995 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9996 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9997 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9998 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9999 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10000 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10001
10002 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10003 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10004 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10005 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10006 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10007 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10008 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10009 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10010
10011 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10012 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10013 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10014 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10015 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10016 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10017 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10018 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10019 occurs.
10020
10021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100228.2.3. HTTP log format
10023----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010024
10025The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
10026is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
10027the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
10028are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
10029emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
10030generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
10031"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
10032which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010033frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
10034is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010035
10036Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
10037slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
10038with a star ('*') after the field name below.
10039
10040 Example :
10041 frontend http-in
10042 mode http
10043 option httplog
10044 log global
10045 default_backend bck
10046
10047 backend static
10048 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10049
10050 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10051 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10052 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010053 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010054
10055 Field Format Extract from the example above
10056 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
10057 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
10058 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
10059 4 frontend_name http-in
10060 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
10061 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
10062 7 status_code 200
10063 8 bytes_read* 2750
10064 9 captured_request_cookie -
10065 10 captured_response_cookie -
10066 11 termination_state ----
10067 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
10068 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10069 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
10070 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
10071 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010072
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010073
10074Detailed fields description :
10075 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010076 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10077 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10078 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10079 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10080 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010081
10082 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010083 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10084 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10085 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010086
10087 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
10088 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
10089 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
10090 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
10091 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
10092
10093 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10094 and processed the connection.
10095
10096 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10097 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10098 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
10099
10100 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10101 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10102 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10103 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
10104 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
10105 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
10106
10107 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
10108 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
10109 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
10110 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
10111 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
10112 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
10113
10114 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10115 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10116 See "Timers" below for more details.
10117
10118 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10119 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10120 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
10121 below for more details.
10122
10123 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
10124 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
10125 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
10126 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
10127 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
10128 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
10129 for more details.
10130
10131 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10132 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10133 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10134 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10135 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10136 details.
10137
10138 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
10139 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
10140 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
10141
10142 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
10143 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
10144 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
10145 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
10146 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
10147 overflowing.
10148
10149 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
10150 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
10151 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
10152 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
10153 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
10154 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
10155 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
10156 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10157
10158 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
10159 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
10160 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
10161 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
10162 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
10163 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
10164 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
10165 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
10166
10167 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10168 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10169 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
10170 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
10171 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
10172 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
10173 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
10174
10175 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010176 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010177 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
10178 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
10179 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010180 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010181 system.
10182
10183 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10184 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10185 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10186 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10187 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10188 caused by a denial of service attack.
10189
10190 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10191 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10192 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10193 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10194 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10195 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10196 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10197 denial of service attack.
10198
10199 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10200 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10201 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10202 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10203 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10204 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10205 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10206 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10207 processed than on other servers.
10208
10209 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10210 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10211 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10212 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10213 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10214 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10215 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10216 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10217 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10218 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10219 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10220 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10221 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10222
10223 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10224 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10225 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10226 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10227 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10228 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10229 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10230 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10231
10232 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10233 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10234 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10235 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10236 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10237 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10238 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10239 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10240 occurs.
10241
10242 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10243 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10244 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10245 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10246 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10247 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10248 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10249 cookies" below for more details.
10250
10251 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10252 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10253 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10254 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10255 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10256 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10257 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10258 and cookies" below for more details.
10259
10260 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10261 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10262 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10263 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10264 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10265 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10266 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10267 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10268
10269
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200102708.2.4. Custom log format
10271------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010272
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010273The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010274mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010275
10276HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10277Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10278separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10279prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10280
10281Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10282variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10283string formats ("Q").
10284
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010010285If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
10286as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.8). This it useful to add some
10287less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
10288the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
10289
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010290Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10291HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10292
10293Flags are :
10294 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010295 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010296
10297 Example:
10298
10299 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10300 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10301
10302At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10303
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010304 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
10305 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010306
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010307the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010308
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010309 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010310 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010311 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010312
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010313and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10314
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010315 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010316 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10317
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010318Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10319
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010320 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010321 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010322 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10323 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10324 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010325 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
10326 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
10327 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010328 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010329 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010330 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010331 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010332 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010333 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010334 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10335 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010336 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010337 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10338 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010339 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010340 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10341 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010342 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10343 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
10344 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010345 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010346 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
10347 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010348 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010349 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
10350 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
10351 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010352 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010353 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10354 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10355 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10356 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010357 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010358 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010359 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010360 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010361 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010362 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010363 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
10364 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
10365 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010366 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010367 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10368 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010010369 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010370 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010371 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010372 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010373
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010374 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010375
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010010376
103778.2.5. Error log format
10378-----------------------
10379
10380When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
10381protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
10382By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
10383"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
10384will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
10385logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
10386
10387The format looks like this :
10388
10389 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
10390 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
10391 Connection error during SSL handshake
10392
10393 Field Format Extract from the example above
10394 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
10395 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
10396 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
10397 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
10398 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
10399
10400These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
10401failures.
10402
10403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104048.3. Advanced logging options
10405-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010406
10407Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10408just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10409options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10410for more information about their usage.
10411
10412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104138.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10414------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010415
10416It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10417haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10418commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10419monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10420ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10421
10422 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10423 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10424 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10425 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10426
10427 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10428 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10429 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10430 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10431 such as other load-balancers.
10432
10433 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10434 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10435 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10436
10437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104388.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10439----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010440
10441The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10442what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10443or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10444"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10445just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10446log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10447after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10448is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10449with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10450with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10451
10452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104538.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10454------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010455
10456Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10457for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10458"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10459retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10460raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10461a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10462file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10463you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10464"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10465
10466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104678.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10468--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010469
10470Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10471multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10472them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10473"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10474logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10475error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10476and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10477too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10478useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10479alternative.
10480
10481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104828.4. Timing events
10483------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010484
10485Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10486reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10487the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10488frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10489mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10490
10491 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10492 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10493 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10494 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10495 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10496
10497 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10498 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10499 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10500 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10501 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10502
10503 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10504 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10505 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10506 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10507 connection never established.
10508
10509 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10510 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10511 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10512 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10513 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10514 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10515 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10516 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10517 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10518 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10519 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10520
10521 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10522 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10523 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10524 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10525 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10526
10527 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10528
10529 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10530 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10531 negative.
10532
10533These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10534protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10535that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010536due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010537close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10538session has been aborted on timeout.
10539
10540Most common cases :
10541
10542 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10543 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10544 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10545 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10546 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10547 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10548 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10549 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10550 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010551 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10552 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10553 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010554
10555 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10556 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10557 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10558 of ms on remote networks.
10559
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010560 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10561 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10562 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010563
10564 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10565 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10566 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10567 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10568 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10569 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10570 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10571 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10572 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10573 to the server until another one is released.
10574
10575Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10576
10577 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10578 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10579 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10580
10581 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10582 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10583 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10584
10585 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10586 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10587 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10588 flags.
10589
10590 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10591 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10592 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10593 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10594 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10595 the client connection was maintained open.
10596
10597 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10598 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10599 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10600 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10601
10602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106038.5. Session state at disconnection
10604-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010605
10606TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10607"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
106082-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10609each of which has a special meaning :
10610
10611 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10612 session to terminate :
10613
10614 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10615
10616 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10617 server explicitly refused it.
10618
10619 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10620 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10621 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10622 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10623 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10624 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10625
10626 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10627 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10628 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10629 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10630 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10631
10632 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10633 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10634 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10635 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10636 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10637
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010638 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10639 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10640
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010641 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10642 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10643 backup connections when going up.
10644
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010645 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10646
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010647 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10648 send or receive data.
10649
10650 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10651 send or receive data.
10652
10653 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10654 with nothing left in the buffers.
10655
10656 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10657
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010658 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010659 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10660
10661 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10662 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10663 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10664 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10665 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10666
10667 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10668 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10669
10670 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10671 server (HTTP only).
10672
10673 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10674
10675 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10676 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10677 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10678
10679 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10680 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10681 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10682
10683 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10684
10685 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10686 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10687
10688 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10689 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10690 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10691
10692 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10693 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010694 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10695 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010696
10697 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10698 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10699 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10700 another server.
10701
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010702 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010703 server.
10704
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010705 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10706 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10707 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10708 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10709
10710 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10711 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10712 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10713 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10714
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010715 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10716 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10717 "use-server" rule).
10718
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010719 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10720
10721 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10722 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10723
10724 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10725
10726 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10727 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10728 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10729
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010730 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10731 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10732 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10733 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10734 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010736 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10737
10738 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10739 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10740
10741 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10742
10743 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10744
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010745The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10746was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010747helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10748starvation, attacks, etc...
10749
10750The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10751alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10752easier finding and understanding.
10753
10754 Flags Reason
10755
10756 -- Normal termination.
10757
10758 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10759 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10760 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10761 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10762
10763 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10764 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10765 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10766 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10767 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10768 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010769
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010770 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10771 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010772 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010773
10774 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10775 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10776 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10777
10778 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10779 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10780 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10781 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10782 the server takes too long to respond.
10783
10784 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10785 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10786 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10787 long a time to respond.
10788
10789 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10790 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10791 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10792 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10793 and the client.
10794
10795 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10796 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10797 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10798 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10799 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10800 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10801
10802 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10803 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010804 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10805 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10806 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10807 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010809 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010810 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10811 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10812 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10813 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10814 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10815
10816 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10817 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10818 503 or 504 here.
10819
10820 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10821 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10822 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10823 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10824 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10825
10826 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10827 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010828 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010829 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10830 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10831
10832 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10833 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10834 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10835 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10836 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10837 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10838 between haproxy and the server.
10839
10840 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10841 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10842 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10843 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10844 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10845 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10846 solution is to fix the application.
10847
10848 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10849 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10850 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10851 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10852 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10853 external attacks.
10854
10855 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10856 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010857 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010858 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10859 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10860
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010861 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10862 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10863 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10864 the client.
10865
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010866 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10867 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10868 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10869 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010870 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10871 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10872 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10873 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10874 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010875
10876 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10877 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10878 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10879 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10880
10881 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10882 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10883 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10884 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10885
10886 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10887 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10888 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10889 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10890
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010891The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10892persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10893important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10894re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10895
10896 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10897
10898 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10899 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10900 set on a GET request.
10901
10902 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10903 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010904 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010905 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10906
10907 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10908 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10909 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10910
10911 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10912 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10913 already got a cookie.
10914
10915 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10916 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10917 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10918 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10919 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10920
10921 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10922 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10923 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10924
10925 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10926 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10927 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10928
10929 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10930 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10931
10932 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10933 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10934 then advertised in the response.
10935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109378.6. Non-printable characters
10938-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010939
10940In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10941consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10942converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10943prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10944being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10945escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10946is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10947'}' when logging headers.
10948
10949Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10950issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10951containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10952
10953Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10954the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10955performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10956
10957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109588.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10959---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010960
10961Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10962achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010963section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010964cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10965the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10966the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010967locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010968not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10969user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10970a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10971wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10972
10973 Examples :
10974 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10975 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10976
10977 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10978 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10979
10980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109818.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10982---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010983
10984Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10985proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10986the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10987server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10988
10989Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10990response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010991section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010992
10993It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010994time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10995appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010996are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10997and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10998follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10999request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11000in the logs.
11001
11002 Example :
11003 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11004 listen proxy-out
11005 mode http
11006 option httplog
11007 option logasap
11008 log global
11009 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
11010
11011 # log the name of the virtual server
11012 capture request header Host len 20
11013
11014 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
11015 capture request header Content-Length len 10
11016
11017 # log the beginning of the referrer
11018 capture request header Referer len 20
11019
11020 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
11021 capture response header Server len 20
11022
11023 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
11024 capture response header Content-Length len 10
11025
11026 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
11027 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
11028
11029 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
11030 capture response header Via len 20
11031
11032 # log the URL location during a redirection
11033 capture response header Location len 20
11034
11035 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
11036 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
11037 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11038 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
11039 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
11040
11041 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11042 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11043 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11044 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011045 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011046
11047 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
11048 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
11049 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
11050 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
11051 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011052 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011053
11054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110558.9. Examples of logs
11056---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011057
11058These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
11059them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
11060reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
11061
11062 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
11063 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11064 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11065
11066 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
11067 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
11068
11069 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
11070 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
11071 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
11072
11073 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
11074 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
11075
11076 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
11077 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
11078 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
11079
11080 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011081 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011082 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
11083 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
11084
11085 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
11086 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
11087 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
11088
11089 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
11090 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011091 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011092 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
11093 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
11094 to return the 502 and not the server.
11095
11096 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011097 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011098
11099 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
11100 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
11101 Nothing was sent to any server.
11102
11103 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
11104 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
11105
11106 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
11107 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
11108 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
11109 send a 408 return code to the client.
11110
11111 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
11112 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
11113
11114 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
11115 5 seconds ("c----").
11116
11117 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
11118 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011119 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011120
11121 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011122 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011123 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
11124 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
11125 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
11126 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
11127 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011128
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111309. Statistics and monitoring
11131----------------------------
11132
11133It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
11134mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
11135CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
11136Unix socket.
11137
11138
111399.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011140---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011141
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010011142The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
11143page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
11144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011145 0. pxname: proxy name
11146 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
11147 for server)
11148 2. qcur: current queued requests
11149 3. qmax: max queued requests
11150 4. scur: current sessions
11151 5. smax: max sessions
11152 6. slim: sessions limit
11153 7. stot: total sessions
11154 8. bin: bytes in
11155 9. bout: bytes out
11156 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011157 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011158 12. ereq: request errors
11159 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011160 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011161 15. wretr: retries (warning)
11162 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010011163 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010011164 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
11165 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
11166 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
11167 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
11168 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
11169 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
11170 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
11171 25. qlimit: queue limit
11172 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
11173 27. iid: unique proxy id
11174 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
11175 29. throttle: warm up status
11176 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
11177 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020011178 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020011179 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
11180 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
11181 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011182 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011183 UNK -> unknown
11184 INI -> initializing
11185 SOCKERR -> socket error
11186 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
11187 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
11188 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
11189 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
11190 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
11191 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11192 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11193 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
11194 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
11195 disable-on-404
11196 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11197 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11198 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020011199 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
11200 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011201 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
11202 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
11203 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
11204 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
11205 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
11206 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011207 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
11208 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
11209 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
11210 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010011211 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
11212 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010011213 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
11214 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
11215 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010011216 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011217
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112199.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011220-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011221
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011222The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011223must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
11224is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
11225a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
11226risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
11227followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
11228given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
11229then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
11230to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011231
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011232It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
11233on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
11234own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011235
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011236clear counters
11237 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
11238 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
11239 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
11240 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
11241 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11242
11243clear counters all
11244 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11245 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11246 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11247
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011248clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11249 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11250
11251 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11252 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11253 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11254 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11255 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11256 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11257
11258 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11259
11260 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11261 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11262 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11263 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11264 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11265 the ACLs :
11266
11267 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11268 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11269 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11270 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11271 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11272 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11273
11274 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011275 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11276 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011277
11278 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011279 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011280 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011281 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11282 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11283 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11284 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011285
11286 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11287
11288 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011289 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011290 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11291 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011292 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11293 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11294 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011295
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011296disable frontend <frontend>
11297 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11298 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11299 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11300 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11301 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11302 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11303 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11304 on the stats page.
11305
11306 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11307 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11308
11309 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11310 level "admin".
11311
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011312disable server <backend>/<server>
11313 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11314 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11315 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11316 during the maintenance.
11317
11318 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11319 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11320
11321 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011322 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011323
11324 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11325 level "admin".
11326
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011327enable frontend <frontend>
11328 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11329 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11330 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11331 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11332 which was disabled.
11333
11334 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11335 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11336
11337 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11338 level "admin".
11339
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011340enable server <backend>/<server>
11341 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11342 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11343
11344 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011345 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011346
11347 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11348 level "admin".
11349
11350get weight <backend>/<server>
11351 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11352 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11353 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11354 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11355 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011356 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011357
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011358help
11359 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11360 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011361
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011362prompt
11363 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11364 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11365 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11366 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11367 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11368 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11369 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11370 command.
11371
11372quit
11373 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011374
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011375set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011376 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11377 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11378 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11379 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11380 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011381 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11382 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11383
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011384set maxconn global <maxconn>
11385 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11386 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11387 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11388 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11389 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11390 setting.
11391
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011392set rate-limit connections global <value>
11393 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11394 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11395 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11396 is passed in number of connections per second.
11397
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011398set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11399 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11400 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010011401 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
11402 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011403
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011404set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11405 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11406 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11407 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11408 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11409 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11410
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011411set timeout cli <delay>
11412 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11413 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11414 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11415
11416set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11417 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11418 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11419 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11420 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11421 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11422 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11423 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11424 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11425 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11426 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11427 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11428 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11429 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011430 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011431
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011432show errors [<iid>]
11433 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11434 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011435 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11436 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11437 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011438
11439 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11440 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11441 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11442 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11443 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11444 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11445 are reported too.
11446
11447 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11448 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11449 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11450 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11451 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11452 code.
11453
11454 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11455 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11456 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11457 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11458 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11459 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11460 line.
11461
11462 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011463 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11464 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011465 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11466 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11467
11468 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11469 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11470 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11471 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11472 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11473 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11474 00204+ minal\r\n
11475 00211 \r\n
11476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011477 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011478 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11479 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11480 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11481 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11482 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11483 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011484
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011485show info
11486 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11487
11488show sess
11489 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011490 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11491 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11492
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011493show sess <id>
11494 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11495 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11496 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11497 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11498 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010011499 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
11500 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
11501 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011502
11503show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11504 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11505 possible to dump only selected items :
11506 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11507 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11508 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11509 for example:
11510 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11511 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11512 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11513
11514 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011515 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11516 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011517 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11518 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11519 Nbproc: 1
11520 Process_num: 1
11521 (...)
11522
11523 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11524 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11525 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11526 (...)
11527 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11528
11529 $
11530
11531 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11532 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11533 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11534 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011535 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011536
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011537show table
11538 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11539 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11540 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11541 entries currently in use.
11542
11543 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011544 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011545 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11546 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011547
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011548show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011549 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11550 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11551 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011552 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11553
11554 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11555 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11556 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11557 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11558 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11559
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011560 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11561 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11562 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11563 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11564 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11565 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11566
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011567
11568 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011569 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11570 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011571
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011572 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011573 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011574 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011575 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11576 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11577 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11578 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011579
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011580 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011581 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011582 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11583 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011584
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011585 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11586 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011587 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011588 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11589 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011590
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011591 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11592 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011593 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011594 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11595 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11596
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011597 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11598 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11599 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11600 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11601 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11602
11603 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11604 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11605 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011606 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11607 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011608 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11609 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011610
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011611shutdown frontend <frontend>
11612 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11613 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11614 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11615 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11616 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11617 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11618 once it is terminated.
11619
11620 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11621 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11622
11623 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11624 level "admin".
11625
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011626shutdown session <id>
11627 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11628 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11629 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11630 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11631 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11632 flag in the logs.
11633
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011634shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11635 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11636 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11637 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11638 'K' flag in the logs.
11639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011640/*
11641 * Local variables:
11642 * fill-column: 79
11643 * End:
11644 */